316 40 65MB
English Pages [520] Year 1960
THE mACmillAH
OF
•
illGliSi"!
HANDBOOK KEY GRAMMAR AND USAGE Case Agreement
Sentence Fragment
4
Pronouns:
^
Run-together Sentence
D
Adjectives
O
Subject
O
Verb Forms
1
and
Yerii
& Adverbs
MECHANICS w
Manuscript: Form
O
Capitals
&
Revision
V 10
Abbreviations
& Numbers
Italics
II Syllabication & Hyphens
PUNCTUATION End Punctuation
16
Quotation Marks
Comma
1/
Colon
14
Semicolon
18
Parentheses
15
Apostrophe
19
Too Much Punctuation
12 I
O
& Dash &
SPELLING
20
Spelling Ust
&
Rules
21
Similar Forms
Brackets
HANDBOOK KEY [WORDS AND PHRASES
22
Exactness
23
Appropriateness: Usage
24
Idioms
jLD
OA ZO 07 Z/
Concreteness
Wordiness
^
Conciseness:
w. .J Vividness:
Repetition
Metaphors triteness
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
28
Sentence Unity:
i£7
3^
^'^''* "" ''®'"* *^'
Subordination
3d
Parallel Structure
OU
Reference of Pronouns
36
Comparisons
O
Proper Arrangement
37
Words
Dangling Modifiers
38
Variety
39
Awkwardness & Obscurity
I
32 OQ OO
c Emphasis: .
.
^ ®^ Mu^ch^*^
Position
Active or Passive
Left
^*®^
Out
PHS
40
Adequate Development
XO 4Z
Coherence:
41
Unity in Paragraph
43
Point of
^
Arrangement
.
44 GLOSSARY'
View
Transitions
Digitized by the Internet Archive in
2011
http://www.archive.org/details/macmillanhandboOOkier
L
THE MACMILLAN HANDBOOK OF ENGLISH
FOURTH EDITION
JOHN M.
KIERZEK and
WALKER GIBSON
!
THE MACMILLAN HANDBOOK OF ENGLISH
THE
MACMILLAN COMPANY New
York
© The Macmillan Company
Fourth Edition
1960
—
no part of this book may be reproduced in any form without permission in writing from the publisher, except by a reviewer who wishes to quote brief passages in connection with a review written for inclusion in magazine or newspaper. All rights reserved
Fifth Printing 1964
Library of Congress catalog card number: 60-5258
The Macmillan Company, New York Brctt-Macmillan Ltd., Gait, Ontario Printed in the United States of America
M. Kierzek copyright 1939, 1947 and 1954 by The Macmillan Company
Previous editions by John
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS The
and Canadian publishers and authors'
following British
agents have kindly granted permission to reproduce material from All quotations granted by
the publications cited.
lishers are credited in the places of their
American pub-
occurrence in the
text.
George Allen & Unwin Ltd. On Education by Bertrand Russell. Edward Arnold Publishers Ltd. Two Cheers for Democracy by E. M. Forster. Jonathan Cape Ltd.: In Our Time by Ernest Hemingway, and The Enormous Room by E. E. Cummings. Cassell & Company Ltd. Into Battle by Winston Churchill. Wm. Collins Sons & Co. Ltd. The Houses in Between by Howard :
:
:
:
Spring. J.
M. Dent & Sons
Ltd.:
Scenes and Portraits by
Van Wyck
Brooks.
Eyre
&
Spottiswoode Ltd.
Autumn
:
Across America by Edwin
Way
Teale.
Hamish Hamilton Ltd. The Big Change by Frederick Lewis and The Second Tree from the Corner by E. B. White. :
&
George G. Harrap
Co. Ltd.
:
Mirror for
Man
Allen,
by Clyde Kluck-
hohn.
William Heinemann Ltd.: Wolfe, Cannery
The Hogarth
Row
Of Time and
the River by
Thomas
by John Steinbeck.
Press Ltd.
:
The Death
of a
Moth and Other
Essays
and Between the Acts by Virginia Woolf. McClelland and Stewart Ltd. Blood, Sweat and Tears by Winston :
Churchill.
Methuen & Co. Ltd. Hills and the Sea by Hilaire Belloc. WiUiam Morris Agency: The Houses in Between by Howard :
Spring.
Paul Reynolds
Ann
&
Son: The
Walkins, Inc.
:
Up
Wind and
Front by
Bill
the
Rain by Thomas Burke.
Mauldin. vii
i9i
PREFACE Those who have used
earlier editions of
The Macmillan Hand-
book of English are familiar with the general plan of Like
its
predecessors, this edition
bined.
It
may
is
this
book.
a rhetoric and handbook com-
be used as either or as both.
Material that can be
most profitably used in classroom instruction has been placed in Material most useful in the marking and revision of
the rhetoric.
papers has been placed in the handbook.
Of
course, one part
supplements the other and enables the teacher to repeat instruction,
when
new
necessary, with
and a
materials
The
fresh approach.
first
part of the book attempts to give the beginner the sort of help-
ful,
common-sense advice about writing that he needs the most
when he
is
The
a beginner.
student
is
introduced to the concept
He
and growing language.
of English as a living
is
then taken
through discussions of grammar as a tool of effective writing, of
and good paragraphs,
building good sentences
to the process of
planning and writing compositions of various kinds and lengths.
The
first
section leads
up
to a discussion of a long
paper based on
the investigation of published material, the most elaborate
and
ambitious project that the student will undertake.
The chapter on Most
the library paper has been entirely rewritten.
of the material in
The system
paper.
of
new, including a new sample research
it is
documentation in footnotes and bibliog-
raphy has been adapted to
suit the
the revised Style Sheet of the
The itself
needs of undergraduates from
Modem
Language
Association.
material of the second part of the book
—
is
organized under forty-four divisions.
—
the
handbook
A comprehensive in-
dex and a theme-correction chart help both the student and the teacher to find any section easily and quickly.
In a
period
methods are
when both
linguistic
in a state of rapid change,
research it is
and pedagogical
essential that a
handix
PREFACE book for students of writing should present from time to time a new and fresh face. Old illustrations become dated; through long use, teaching
devices
lose
their
vitality.
Profiting
from new knowledge, and from the good advice
we have
tried to strengthen
from experience, of other teachers,
and enrich the teaching devices
proved useful and have discarded those that proved weak. of the illustrative material
rewritten.
Most important
simplified so that
its
venient for teacher
is
new;
of
all,
all
of the exercises
more compact and con-
to use.
In the preparation of the fourth edition
we have
received advice
and help from teachers throughout the country, and
we wish
to express
sor
Oscar
and
for his
We
also
have been
perhaps, the handbook has been
forty-four divisions are
and student
that
Much
our deep gratitude.
for that help
Special thanks go to Profes-
New
York University, for his valuable advice help in seeing the book through the press. wish to thank those whose student papers or outlines
Cargill,
we have used
as
examples throughout the book: Hallie Ashton,
Alan Berman, Pat Caven, Shirley Haag, Janet Mcintosh, Marilyn Manley, George R. Powers, Elizabeth Roosa, Michal Rubin, Pearl Swanson, and Audrey Wilsey.
Jeanne
Ball,
John M. Kierzek Walker Gibson
CONTENTS Part
I:
THE EXPRESSION
Chapter
1:
AND COMMUNICATION OF THOUGHT
THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE
The Family
of
Languages
3
Periods of Linguistic Change
4
The Old English Period The Middle English Period Modern English Our Changing Language
5
12
Levels of Usage and Functional Varieties of English
13
6 10
Standard English
16
Standard English: Informal Varieties
21
The Vernacular The Student's Choice
25
Bibliography
31
Chapter 2:
29
THE SENTENCE
A. Grammatical Patterns
32
What Is Grammar? The Parts of Speech Noun
32 34 34
Verb Pronoun
35
Adjective
35
Adverb
36
Preposition
Conjunction
36 36
Interjection
37
35
The Verbals
37
Gerund
38
Participle
38 38
Infinitive
The Elements
of the Simple Sentence
Complements Direct Object Indirect Object
39
40 40 40 xi
CONTENTS Subjective
Objective
Complement Complement
41 41
Retained Object
41
Phrases
42
Prepositional Phrase
42
Verbal Phrase
43
Participial Phrase
43
Absolute Phrase
44
Gerund Phrase
44
Infinitive Phrase
The Elements of The Elements of Noun Clause
the
45
Compound
the
Sentence
Complex Sentence
49
Adjective Clause
50
Adverbial Clause
51
Elements of the Compound-complex Sentence B.
48 48
Rhetorical Patterns
The Problem
of Effectiveness
52 54
54
Long and Short Sentences
56
Uses of Subordination
58
Variation in Order
65
Loose and Periodic Sentences
66
Parallel Structure
and Balance
Euphony and Rhythm
71
THE PARAGRAPH
Chapter 3:
What
74
a Paragraph?
Is
67
Length of Paragraphs
78
The Topic Sentence
78
How
Write a Paragraph
79
Particulars
and Details Examples or Typical Instances
81
Definition
87
to
83
Comparison or Contrast
88
Analogy
90
Methods
in
Combination
Arrangement or Order
in
Paragraphs
Transitions in Paragraphs
Chapter 4:
91
96
Unity in Paragraphs
96 97
THE PROCESS OF PLANNING AND WRITING
Selecting an Appropriate Subject
101
The Autobiographical Sketch
102
xii
CONTENTS The Autobiographical
105
Incident
First Impressions of College
107
The Narrative
108
Incident
110
Descriptions Interpretations of
Home
and Friends
113
Occupations
114
The The
116
Profile Brief,
Informal Book Review
119
Directions, Processes, Organizations
121
"Local Color" Articles
124
Personal Essays
128
Planning the Paper
132
Limiting the Subject
132
Nature of the Plan or Outline
134
The Informal Outline The Process of Synthesis
134
Order
135
The The The The The
134
of Presentation
Chronological Order
135
Inductive Order
135
Order of Enumeration Order of Easy Comprehension Order of Division Conventions of the Formal Outline Beginning the Paper Writing the Paper
136 137 137
138
140 144
Proportion
145
Substance: Use of Details
146
The Ending Chapter 5:
147
WRITING THE LIBRARY PAPER
Importance of the Library Paper
The Use of the Library The Card Catalogue: Basic Guide Call Numbers
151
152 to the Library
152 155
Library of Congress System
156
Dewey Decimal System
156
The Reference Library The General Encyclopedias The Special Encyclopedias The Year Books Guides
to
157 157
157 158
Reference Books
158
Biographical Information Dictionaries and Books of
158
Synonyms
159 xiii
CONTENTS Gazetteers and Atlases
159
Books on Literature
160
Books of Quotations Books on Mythology, Classical Literature Indexes to Periodicals
160 160 160
Indexes to Magazines
160
Indexes to Bulletins
160
Indexes to Newspapers
The
Library Paper
160 162
Choosing the Subject
163
Deciding on the General Field
163
Limiting the Subject
164
Preparing a Working Bibliography
166
Bibliographic Forms
166
Gathering Material and Making Notes on Reading
167
Use
of
169
The
Preliminary Outline
Note Cards
Methods
of Identifying Notes
The Form
of
Notes
169 169
170
Reading and Skimming
170
Evaluating Your Sources
171
Sample Note Cards
171
The The
172
Final Steps:
Writing the Paper
Final Outline
Footnotes:
Where Needed
172 173
Numbering and Spacing Footnotes
173
The Form
174
of Footnotes
Abbreviations in Footnotes
176
Roman Numerals
176
Sample Outline and Library Paper
177
Chapter 6:
LETTER WRITING
The Heading The Inside Address The Salutation or Greeting The Body of the Letter The Complimentary Close The Signature
194
191
192 193 193
194
Sample Business Letter
195
Letters of Application
195
Sample Letter
196
of Application
Invitations, Acceptances, Regrets
198
Faults to Avoid
199
xiv
CONTENTS Part 2:
A HANDBOOK OF WRITING AND REVISION
GRAMMAR AND USAGE 1.
2.
The Sentence Fragment
203
la.
Dependent Clause
206
lb.
Phrase
206
Ic.
Appositive
207
Id.
Uncompleted Thought
2b.
The Comma Splice The Run-together Sentence
209 212
Subject and Verb
When
215
Word
Intervenes
216
3b. Together with, as well as, etc.
216
3a.
3c.
3d. 3e. 3f.
3g.
3h. 3i.
3j.
3k. 4.
207
209
Run-together Sentences 2a.
3.
203
Plural
217
In Nontypical Patterns
With Subject, not Subjective Complement Subjects Joined by and With neither-nor, etc. With each, every, etc. With Collective Nouns With Titles, Clauses, etc. Words Ending in -ics With Relative Pronouns
Pronouns
Gerund
4d. Possessive Case with 4e.
Use
4f.
The Objective Case
4i.
5.
5a.
220 221 221
for Direct
Case after than,
Object
as
With Infinitives Agreement with Antecedent Correct Forms
Awkward Use
225
226 226 227
Adjectives and Adverbs 5.
219 220
228
of oj Phrase
4h. Object of Preposition
4j.
219
223
Nominative Case for Subject 4b. Nominative Case for Subjective Complement 4c. Possessive Case Forms 4a.
4g. Objective
218 218
228 229
230 230 231
236 236
of
Noun Form
Verbs like be, seem, become, etc. Adverb Uses 5d. Nonstandard Uses 5e. Two Forms Distinguished 5f. Comparative and Superlative Forms
237
5b. After
237
5c.
238:
239 240 240
XV
CONTENTS 6.
Verb Forms Use of Appropriate Form 6a. Correct Tense Forms 6.
243
245
6b.
Uses of Subjunctive
249
6c.
Uses of Passive Voice
250
MECHANICS
254
Form and Revision
Manuscript:
7.
7a.
Preparation of Manuscript
7b. Revision of
Manuscript
Word
8a. First
8b.
of Sentence, etc
9a.
9b. 9c.
10a.
261
When
in Proper Sense
Numbers
261
263
263
to Abbreviate
Numbers Written Out to Use Figures
265
When
265
267
For Titles of Books,
10b. Foreign
etc.
Words and Phrases
267
268
Letters, Figures
269
Emphasis Syllabication and Hyphens
270
10c.
Words,
lOd. Italics for 11.
259
Names
with
Common Nouns
Italics
10.
258
260
Abbreviations and
9.
254
Proper Nouns and Adjectives
8c. Titles
8d.
254
259
Capitals
8.
271
11a. Undesirable Division
271
lib. Rules for Proper Division
272
lie.
lid. lie.
Hyphen with Compound Adjective Hyphen in Numbers Special Uses of Hyphen
PUNCTUATION 12.
End Punctuation
To
Indicate Omissions (...)
13.
278 279 281
13c.
Between Co-ordinate Clauses Between Parts of a Series Between Co-ordinate Adjectives
13d,
To
13b.
277 277
after Direct Question
Mark
The Comma
13a.
277
Exclamation Point for Strong Feeling
12d. Question 12e.
273
274
277
12b. Period after Abbreviations 12c.
273
276
12a. Period after Sentence
Prevent Misreading
i3e. After Introductory
xvi
243
Elements
282 283
284
284
285
CONTENTS With Transposed Elements and Contrast With Mild Exclamations, etc. 13h. With Nonrestrictive Clauses 13i. With Parenthetical Elements 13 j. With Absolute Phrases 13k. With Appositives 131. Words Used in Direct Address 13m. With Dialogue Guides 13n. Geographical Names, Dates, Addresses 13f.
287
13g.
287
The Semicolon 14a. In Compound Sentence without Conjunction
14.
14b. 14c.
With Conjunctive Adverbs With Internal Punctuation
-s
To
Plurals of Figures, Letters, etc.
Indicate Omission
With Direct Quotations
With Titles Words Spoken of as Words Words Used in Special Sense With Meanings in Definitions
Commas,
Marks 16h. Quotation Marks with Other Marks 16i. With Dialogue Guides in Quoted Matter 17. The Colon and Dash 17a. Before List or Formal Quotation (Colon) 17b. Special Use between Clauses (Colon) 17c. Dash for Abrupt Break 17d. Dash with Parenthetical Elements 17e. Dash with Appositive or Summary 18. Parentheses and Brackets 16g.
302 304
-
16b. Quotation within Quotation
16f.
302 302
303
Quotation Marks
16e.
298 298
302
15g. In Titles
16d.
293
302
15f,
16c.
293
293
301
Nouns Ending in -s Singular Nouns Ending in With Indefinite Pronouns
15e.
16a.
291
301
15b. Plural
16.
29!
299
The Apostrophe 15a. To Form Possessive
15d.
289
298
15.
15c,
287
Periods with Quotation
304 305
306
306 306 307 307 307
307 309
309 310 311
311
312 313
18a. Parentheses with Explanations
313
18b. Brackets for Interpolations
315
19.
Too Much Punctuation
19a. Superfluous
315
Commas
315
19b. Unnecessary Periods 19c.
Wrong Use
of Question
318
Marks
319 xvii
CONTENTS Exclamation Points
19d. Unnecessary
319
19e.
Overuse of Quotation Marks
319
19f.
Wrong Use
319
Dashes
of
SPELLING 20.
20a.
320
The Spelling Problem The Spelling List
320 323
326
20b. Spelling Rules 21. Similar
Forms
330
WORDS AND PHRASES 22. Exactness
and Use
334 334
of Dictionary
334
22. Exactness
Key Words Words Used in Inexact Sense Vague, Blanket Words
335
22a. Defining
22b. 22c.
336 337 337
22d. Boners
Use
of the Dictionary
338
L The Meaning of a Word 2. The Spelling of a Word 3. The Pronunciation of a Word
340
22e.
Subject, Geographical,
340 340
Usage
Labels:
5.
Derivation of a
6.
Grammatical Information
7.
Idiomatic Phrases
343
8.
Synonyms and Antonyms
343
Word
342 342
346
23. Appropriateness 23.
Use
of Appropriate
Use
23a. Inappropriate
Words
346
of Slang
347
23b, Inappropriate Mixture of Styles 24.
Use
349
of Idiomatic English
24b. Idiomatic
Use
of Prepositions
Value of Concrete,
Specific,
Homely Words
Economy
in
Words Same Word Words with Same Meaning
Use
26a. Repetition of
26b. Repetition of
of
26c.
The Double
26d.
Roundabout Expressions
26e. PufTers
xviii
352 357
26. Conciseness 26,
350 352
Concreteness
25.
347
349
Idioms
24a.
25.
342
4.
that
357
358 360 361 361
361
CONTENTS and Other Modifiers Sounds
26f. Intenslves
361
26g. Repetition of Similar
362
26h. "Fine Writing"
362
and Metaphor and Dangers 27a. Nouns, Modifiers, Verbs 27b. Metaphors 27c. Trite Metaphors and Phrases
27. Vividness
27. Possibilities
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES 28.
Sentence Unity
28a.
Not Enough
Too Much
28c.
Overloading with Details
in Sentence
29b.
The Choppy
Minor Ideas
371
371 371
372 375
378
Style
380
Pronouns
30a. Antecedents Immediately Clear
30b.
368
374
Subordination
29a. Subordinating
30. Reference of
364
366
371
Sentence
in
28b.
29.
364
364
Ambiguous Reference
30c. Indefinite you, they, this, etc.
380 382 383
30d.
Awkward same,
30e.
Agreement with Antecedent
386
30f.
Awkward Reference
386
31.
such, above, etc.
to Title
Proper Arrangement
387
387
1.
Arrangement of Sentence Parts The Problem of only, not
2.
Phrases
388
3.
Clauses
389
4.
Squinting Modifiers
389
5.
The Split Infinitive Words Belonging Near Each Other
390
31. Clear
6.
32.
385
Dangling Modifiers
32a. Dangling Modifiers
Exceptions
390 392 392 393
1.
Absolute Phrase
393
2.
Idiomatic Phrases
393
Objectionable Danglers
Gerund
1.
Participle or
2.
Infinitive
3.
Phrase of Result
32b. Misrelated Elliptical Clauses 32c.
387
Other Misrelated Elements
393
394
394 394 395 395
xix
CONTENTS 33.
Emphasis
in the Sentence
33. Devices to
Show
397
Relative Importance
The Emphatic Position The Periodic Form 33c. The Overused Passive Voice 34. Shift in Point of View 33a.
33b.
From
Active to Passive Voice
34b. Shifts in Tense 34c. Shift in
34f.
34g.
Person
From Indirect to Direct From Formal to Colloquial Mixed Constructions
34i.
Mixed
Figures of Speech
35a. Parallel Structure for Parallel Ideas
35c. 36.
The and which Construction The False Parallel
and Complete Comparisons 36b. Unfinished Comparisons for Clearness
404 405 405
407
409 410 411
413
414 414 415
1.
Omission of that Omission of Part of Verb Phrase
3.
Words in Parallel Series Words Understood in Double Capacity
415
4. 5.
Idiomatic Prepositions
415
38. Variety in Length, Structure
Awkwardness and Obscurity Confused and Obscure Sentences
39.
THE PARAGRAPH Adequate Development
415
416 416 420
420
422 422
40a. Paragraph Length
422
40b. Concrete Details in Paragraph
425
41.
XX
404
2.
38. Variety
40.
403
414
37.
39.
402
411
Comparisons
36a. Logical
Words Left Out 37. Words Necessary
402
407
Parallel Structure
35b.
401
403 Style
34h. Unintentional Absurdity
35.
398
400
402
Number and
34d. Shift in Subject or Perspective 34e.
397
401
34. Illogical Shifts Undesirable
34a.
397
Paragraph Unity
426
41a. Unity in Paragraphs
426
41b. Topic Sentence as Aid to Unity
428
CONTENTS 42.
Coherence in Paragraphs Arrangement of Details
42a.
42b.
Use
43. Point of
of Connectives
43. Consistent Point of
43a. In
and Transitions
View
429
429 431
433
View
Time and Space Tone
433 433
43b. Consistent
436
43c. Consistent Attitude
437
GLOSSARY
439
A
439
44.
INDEX
Glossary of Usage
461
XXI
/
THE EXPRESSION /
AND COMMUNICATION OF THOUGHT
Part
1
/
1
LANGUAGE /
THE ENGLISH
me
chapter
J?is andwearde llf manna on eorgan to uncuS is, swylc swa ]?u aet swaesendum sitte mid Jpinum ealdormannum gnd Jpegnum on wintertlde, gnd sie fyr onseled gnd 1pm heall gewyrmed, gnd hit rine, gnd sniwe, gnd styrme ute; cume an spearwa gnd hraedlice ]:>aet hus J^urhfleo, cume ]:>urh oJ:>re duru in ]?urh Hwaet he on J^a tid Ipe he inne biS, ne biS hrinen mid ]?y 6J?re ut gewite. storme J?aes vvintres; ac ]paet bi3 an eagan bryhtm gnd ]:>aet Isesste faec, ac he sona of wintra on Jpone winter eft cymeS. Swa }?onne Ipis mgnna lif to medmiclum faece aetyweS; hwaet ]?aer foregange, ogge hwaet Jpaer ^efterfylige, we ne cunnan. For Son gif )?eos lar owiht cuSlicre gnd gerisenlicre br^nge,
"Jjyslic
is
wiSmetenesse
}?a2s
weorjpe
It is
gesewen, }?u cyning,
|?aere
is ]:>aet
tide
we
];>e
us
|?£Ere fylgen."^
a long road that our English language has traveled since
that day
more than
thirteen centuries ago
and, with the dignity of one good to his king,
"Now,
in the native
known by
this
is
the
way
it
man
when
the old thane arose
speaking to another, said
looks to me.
..." He spoke
tongue of the inhabitants of England, a language
scholars as
Anglo-Saxon or Old English.
than any other tongue, in the additions of
new
blood,
is
more and all
This,
spite of all the intermarriages
the one important great-ancestor of
which you and I speak and The Family of Languages. The position
the English language
write.
of
English in the
shown by the table on page 8. English is one of a number of West Germanic languages. The Germanic group of languages is one of a number of groups, family tree of Indo-European languages
*
is
See page 17 for a free translation.
3
THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE descended from a hypothetical parent language, the Indo-
all
European.
All this
is
true yet highly misleading unless
we
re-
member
that, although English is mainly Germanic in its original and in the way it relates words in sentences, the words themselves come mostly from other languages. Less than a quarter of modem English words are Germanic in origin, whereas over half are derived from Latin. The rest of our English vocabulary has been borrowed from a whole range of miscellaneous languages ancient Greek, Scandinavian, French, Spanish, Italian, German, Russian, Arabic, Persian, American Indian, and many others. It was a very long time ago when families or tribes first broke away from the parent Indo-European group of people and, through
history
made inevitable the formation of separate languages. how this must have happened, and about the relaamong the various languages, have been dug up and
separation,
The
facts
tionships
about
pieced together comparatively recently, with a ratiocinative
an infant. No has ever heard or seen an actual Indo-European word.
makes a
that
fictional detective look like
that this language
documented it
existed
sort of guess
a
is
— and
yet, like
almost as good as a proved
is
European language did
home
the
plants of
who
fact.
—a
most
Very
man
The
idea
particularly well-
scientific hypotheses,
likely
a parent Indo-
scholars are even willing to place
exist;
somewhere in central east words for animals and a temperate European cHmate and the absence of any of those
A
Europe.
hypothesis
skill
living
few
words relating
spoke
it
as
clues, like the existence of
to sea or ocean,
gave the philologists their interesting
lead.
And as
how language itself originated, your guess is as good Nobody knows, and at present there does not
as to
anybody
else's.
Scholars to be any possibility that anybody ever will know. amuse themselves with ingenious guesses, but they do not pre-
seem
tend that their guesses are hypotheses. Periods of Linguistic Change.
Students of the English language
growth into three main periods: the 450 to 1100; the Middle English Period, from 1100 to 1500; and the Modem English Period, from 1500 to the present time. It must not be assumed, however, that in any have divided
Old English
its
historical
Period, from
THE OLD ENGLISH PERIOD one year the people of England stopped speaking one kind of language and began speaking another.
and
were
yet there
The change was
gradual,
definite historical events occurring at the times
mentioned which caused a more rapid change
in the
language of
These events were the invasion of England
the people of England.
by the Angles, Saxons, and Jutes
in 449, the
Norman Conquest
in
1066, and the coming of the English Renaissance about 1500.
There were, of course, people in England before 450. known inhabitants of England were the Britons, a
earliest
branch of the Indo-European family, with
whom
Caesar's
The Celtic
Roman
Almost a cenarmies came into contact in the summer of 55 b.c. tury later the Roman armies of Claudius returned to England and proceeded in earnest to conquer and enslave the native Britons.
Four centuries
Roman
of
rule left the natives so thoroughly
manized and dependent upon
home
Romans
forced the
colonies,
Britons were
the
their masters that
against
helpless
when
from
to pull in their armies
the
Ro-
trouble at
their distant
attacks
of
their
northern neighbors.
According in
to a later historian,
some Saxon
tribes
northern invaders.
a native prince, Vortigern, called
from the mainland
of
Europe
to fight the
Unfortunately for the Britons, these liberators
quickly took the entire country into protective custody and proved that spears as
and axes can be instruments
What
an atom bomb.
retreated westward
of genocide as devastating
Britons survived the wars
and massacres
and northward; a few must have remained, unhappy servility. First Britons and
existing as best they could in
Romans occupied
then Britons and
dred years of known history and
The
English language.
the Angles, the Saxons,
coming
of the
practically
real history of
and the
The Old English Period. first
the English land for five hun-
left
no trace upon our
our language begins with
Jutes.
From
449, the legendary date of the
Saxons to England, to 1066, when William the
Bastard defeated and killed the Saxon King Harold at the Battle of Hastings,
is
a period of 616 years
as long as the present life
Many
things can
England became
happen
in
— a time span almost four times
span of the great American republic.
616
years,
and many things did happen. and largely Christianized.
civilized, prosperous,
THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE
Under
and the organand monasteries were set up. PoHtically, the EngHsh land was divided up among four important kingdoms Northumbria, Mercia, Wessex, and Kent which at various times rose to temporal importance and then declined, as kingdoms do in a space of six hundred years. These kingdoms, too, were visited by trouble of the kind that they had brought upon the Britons. Another Germanic people, the Danes, descended upon the island in raids of growing magnitude over two centuries of time and came close to drawing the final curtain over the first scene of what was to become the great drama of the English-speaking peoples. The Danes and the Anglo-Saxons were, in a way, kinsfolk, and although kinship did not mellow the savagery of feud or war, it may have been one reason why the two people could arrange to live together at first in a sort of cold war and later in an armed friendship. Gradually the Danes were absorbed by the more stubborn and also more civilized breed, and although the Danes, like most invaders, wantonly pillaged libraries and burned books, enough of ized
the influence of the Christian missionaries
church,
schools
—
we
the written language of the Anglo-Saxons survived so that
know
pretty well
what
sort of
speech our ancestors used.
guage remained predominantly Anglo-Saxon; the Norse additions
present vocabulary.
words as the verbs skirt; the
names
amounted
From
to less
than
the Danish
is
it
five
The
lan-
estimated that
per cent of our
we have such everyday
want; the nouns sky, sister, them; and hundreds of place
give, hit, raise, take,
pronoun forms
they, their,
in the eastern part of England,
which was once known
as
the Danelaw.
The Middle English Period. About a century and a half before Old English Period, another Scandinavian people, the Normans (Norsemen), landed on the Normandy beaches, took over the country, settled down, and adopted the language and culture of the French. In 1066, William, Duke of Normandy,
the end of the
after a
tempestuous and unsavory career in
his
own
country, laid
claim to the EngHsh throne. The Norman Conquest followed his What eventually hapdecisive victory at the Battle of Hastings. pened to the language of England can be better understood if one
remembers that the Norman Conquest was not a mass migration
of
THE MIDDLE ENGLISH PERIOD one people intent upon displacing another, but rather the personal adventure of a dictator grasping for more power and distinction.
William the Conqueror proceeded to subdue Anglo-Saxon England from above, killing and replacing the native rulers, confis-
what property was worth taking and parceling it out to his Meanwhile, life followers, promulgating new laws and decrees. went on; the work was done, crops were grown, trade revived, and the common people continued to speak their native Anglo-Saxon speech. The language of the court and the upper classes was cating
Norman
French.
The language
was Latin, the
of the church
universal language of that day.
For a time England continued to be time a
number
of things
In the course of
trilingual.
happened which tended
to separate the
English people from their neighbors across the Channel. rulers
it
became
increasingly
more important
to
For the be kings of Eng-
land than to remain dukes of a small French province.
Wars with
France and Scotland, the Crusades, a break with the Church of
Rome,
the
rise of
the middle classes,
all
tended to foster a sense of
and importance.
By the middle of the fourteenth became the accepted language of the ruling classes, the law courts, and the church. More than that, one dialect of the three which had persisted since the earliest Anglo-Saxon times, the East Midland dialect of London and its governmental agencies, emerged as the leading language of England, a position which it has held to this day. The fact that
national unity
century, English, not French or Latin,
Chaucer, a Londoner, wrote his popular
may have
helped to establish
stories
in
this
dialect
it.
emerged was greatly enriched by additions of Norman French words. As one might expect, most of these words came out of the social, political, and economic life in which the Normans dominated. From the language of government we get such words as parliament, crown, duke, sovereign; from the law courts judge, jury, justice, jail, plaintiff; from feudal Naturally, the English that
life
and the
vassal,
chamber.
names
life
liege,
And
of the
of the higher social classes castle, count, baron,
war, prison,
barber,
grocer,
as an example of the fact same object survived, there
tailor,
mantle, labor,
that often is
two
sets of
the old joke that
THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE Sanskrit
Indian
Prakrit, etc.
Iranian
Gypsy Old Persian Zend
Hindustani, 1.
Indo-Iranian
Modern 2.
Armenian
3.
Hellenic
etc.
Persian, etc
Ionic Attic
Modern
Doric
Greek
^olic 4.
Albanian
Oscan; Umbrian 5.
French Spanish
Italic
Latin
Italian
Portuguese
Roumanian Icelandic
Indo-European
Norse
Danish Swedish
(North)
Norwegian
Gothic 6.
Germanic
(East)
High
West
Low
German Austrian
Old Saxon Dutch; Flemish Frisian
Anglo-Saxon (English) Prussian Lithuanian,
Baltic
7.
etc.
Russian Bulgarian
Balto-Slavic Slavic
Czech Polish
Gallic
(old Gaul) Irish
Gaelic
Scotch-Gaelic
Manx
I Celtic
Welsh Cymric
Cornish Breton
THE MIDDLE ENGLISH PERIOD whereas the Saxon knew
domestic animals on the hoof as and deer (all of Anglo-Saxon derivaknew them on the table as pork, mutton, his
swine, sheep, cow, calf, ox, tion), the
Norman
beef, veal,
and venison
By
lord
(all of
Norman
derivation).
the end of the fourteenth century the language
on a
modem
distinctly
samples, the
first
look.
If
we examine
had taken
closely the following
Anglo-Saxon, the second from the time of
in
Chaucer, the third from the time of Shakespeare and King James of
Great Britain, and the
begins to
come
come
strange
less
last
into focus.
from the
The
present, the
I
whole thing
strange Anglo-Saxon words be-
and puzzling, and we seem
be observing, in
to
a fashion, the coming of age of our language.
And
eft
he ongan hi
gegaderod, swa
):)aet
And
])2l
laeran.
And him
waes mycel wass;
sae
m^negu
and
call
to
sco
And he hi fela on bigspellum iSrde, and GehyraS: Ut eode se saedere his saed to sawenne. he seow, sum feoU wig j^one weg, and fugelas comon and hit Sum feoU ofer stanscyligean, J^ar hit naefde mycele eor^an, and
m^negu ymbe ]?a him to cwaeS on fraeton.
aet J^aere sae
he on scip eode, and on baere
sae
waes on lande.
his lare,
sona up eode; and for )?am hit naefde eor^an Jpiccnesse,
sunne hit forswaelde, and
sum feoU on wasstm ne
hit forscranc, for
]:)omas; Jpa stigon
baer.
And sum
fcoll
)?a hit iip
eode, seo
}7am hit wyrtruman nasfde.
And
Sa Jjomas and forSrysmodon ]?aet, and hit on god land, and hit sealde uppstigendne
and wexendne waestm; and an brohte
J^ritigfealdne,
sum
syxtigfealdne,
sum
hundfealdne.
— From the Anglo-Saxon translation of the Gospels, about the year 1000. And eft Jhesus bigan to teche at the see; and myche puple was gaderid to hym, so that he wente in to a boot, and sat in the see, and al the puple was aboute the see on the loond. And he taughte hem in parablis many thingis. And he seide to hem in his techyng. Here ye. Lo, a man sowynge goith out to sowe. And the while he sowith, summe seed felde aboute the weie, and briddis of heuene camen, and eeten it. Othere felde doun on stony places, where it had not myche erthe; and anoon it spronge vp, for it had not dcpnesse of erthe. And whanne the sunne roos vp, it welewide for heete, and it driede vp, for it hadde no roote. And othere felde doun in to thomes, and thornes sprongen vp, and strangliden it, and it yaf not fruyt. And other felde doun in to good loond, and yaf fruyt, springynge vp, and wexynge; and oon broughte thretti foold, and oon sixti fold, and oon an hundrid fold.
—From
translation
about 1388.
by John Wycliffe, about 1380, revised by John Purvey,
THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE
And he began him
again to teach by the sea side: and there was gathered unto
a great multitude, so that he entered into a ship, and sat in the sea: and
the whole multitude things by parables,
was by the sea on the land. and said unto them in his
And he
taught them
many
doctrine, Hearken; Behold,
And it came to pass, as he sowed, some fell and the fowls of the air came and devoured it. And some fell on stony ground, where it had not much earth; and immediately it sprang up, because it had no depth of earth: But when the sun was up, it was scorched; and because it had no root it withered away. And some fell among thorns, and the thorns grew up, and choked it, and it yielded no fruit. And other fell on good ground, and did yield fruit that sprang up and increased, and brought forth, some thirty, and some sixty, and some a there went out a sower to sow:
by the way
side,
hundred.
— From King James Version of 1611. sea.
And
about him, so that he got into a boat and
sat in
Again he began to teach beside the
a very large it
on the
crowd gathered and the whole
sea;
crowd was beside the sea on the land. And he taught them many things in parables, and in his teaching he said to them: "Listen! A sower went out to sow. And as he sowed, some seed fell along the path, and the birds came and devoured it. Other seed fell on rocky ground, where it had not much soil, and immediately it sprang up, since it had no depth of soil; and when the sun rose it was scorched, and since it had no root it withered away. Other seed fell among thorns and the thorns grew up and choked it, and it yielded no grain. And other seeds fell into good soil and brought forth grain, growing up and increasing and yielding thirtyfold and sixtyfold and a hundredfold."
— From
the Revised Standard Version of 1952.
tional Council of
Nelson
&
Sons.
By permission
of the
Na-
United States and Thomas Copyright 1952 by the National Council of Churches of Churches of Christ
in the
Christ in the United States.
Modern
English.
beginning of the
two events set
up
10
Modem
English Period because near that time
William Caxton and England began to impulses from the continental European Renaissance. of the English language since 1500 is one of gradual
his printing press in
history
year 1500 has been arbitrarily set for the
of superlative importance took place:
feel the first
The
The
England
in 1476,
MODERN ENGLISH growth and enrichment, not of \iolent change, mainly because
no foreign invader has again succeeded in setting foot on the tight There have been, it is true, "movements," like the
Uttle island.
swinging of a pendulum, which hurried or retarded the change.
The Elizabethan Age enriched structure
lowed,
the language in both flexibility of
The
and added vocabulary.
stressed
correctness,
Classical Period,
conciseness,
and
which
simplicity.
fol-
In the
Romantic Period the pendulum swung to the other extreme. In addition to this rhythmic swing from the liberal attitude to the conservative and back to the liberal, there were other influences at work. The simple dignity of the King James Bible of 1611 acted as a brake upon the exuberancy of both Romanticists and Latinists. From time to time some writer rediscovered the virtues of the speech of the common people. England became first a world empire and then the mother country of a world commonwealth of nations, and the speech of the people who inhabited one half of a little island became a world language. Several other profound influences upon the course which the English language took must be mentioned here. One is the standardizing influence of the dictionaries, the grammars, and the printing houses, which beginning in the eighteenth century set up standards of correctness first in spelling, then in pronunciation and meaning, and more recently in good usage. Another is the elevating influence of almost universal education. A third, and now probably the most powerful influence,
is
that of television, radio,
and motion pictures. The speech of the radio and television announcer and newscaster has emerged as the standard speech of the nation today and tomorrow, it seems probable, of the whole
—
English-speaking world.
powerful;
regional
This standardizing influence
differences
always remain, tend to grow
Two
wars have done their
in less
bit to
is
extremely
America, although they
prominent and
less
scramble dialects in
may
important.
this country,
and, on the international scene, to mix Australians, Americans,
and
British;
hence
it
need not be rash prophecy
tional differences in pronunciation less
and usage
to
assume that na-
will in
time become
noticeable.
n
THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE
When
Our Changing Language.
guage, he should be able to discern a
The
—
one looks back upon the
hundred years which are the Ufe span
fifteen
number
of the
EngHsh
history of our language has been a history of constant
at times a slow, almost
been a
living,
growing organism
At one extreme folk,
Our language
has never been
been the possession not of one
at all times has
norant
it
;
who
used
it
it
was the property
it
down
to give
a
beauty.
little
it
Another
static. is
that language
group but of
of the
common,
in the daily business of their living,
was the ward
strument and a sign of
has always
class or
as they used their animals or their kitchen pots
other extreme
change
at other times a
which emerges from such a study
significant truth
many.
an imperceptible change,
between two languages.
violent collision
lan-
of significant truths.
and pans.
ig-
much At the
who respected it as an inand who strove by writing it
of those
civilization,
some permanence,
order, dignity, and,
if
possible,
As we consider our changing language, we should note here two developments that are of special and immediate importance to
One
is
us.
that since the time of the Anglo-Saxons there has been an
almost complete reversal of the different devices for showing the relationship of
words
in a sentence.
Anglo-Saxon was a language
many inflections. Modem English has few inflections. We must now depend largely on word order and on function words to of
convey the meanings that the older language did by means of changes in the forms of words.
Function words, you should under-
and a few others which are used primarily to show relationships among other words. A few inflections, however, have survived. And when some word
stand, are
words
inflections
come
like prepositions, conjunctions,
in conflict
may be trouble when we turn whom and me or /. The
with word order, there
we who
for the users of the language, as
shall see later
our attention to such matters as
or
second fact attitudes tury, fix
we must
consider
that as language
toward language forms change
for example,
also.
itself
The
changes, our
eighteenth cen-
produced from various sources a tendency
the language into patterns not always in accord with the
people actually used
12
is
it.
At the present time there
is
to
way
a strong
LEVELS
OF USAGE AND FUNCTIONAL VARIETIES OF ENGLISH
tendency to restudy and re-evaluate language practices in terms of
and speak. Usage and Functional Varieties of
the ways in which people write Levels of
English.
It
has
been customary to divide the living language of the present into three
main levels of usage, each characterized by certain distinctive and conventions. At the top is "formal" English; at the
practices
bottom
the spoken language
is
informal writing and everyday speech.
however,
like
most attempts
human
of
behavior,
somehow
habits of people
as they refused to
grammarians.
One
to classify
conform
refuse to
conform
The word
This
it
the
is
the
classification,
The language
to these classifications,
to the rules of the eighteenth-century
"level"
does not climb upstairs
—
itself is
none too
culturally, that
congressman, or descend to
his cultural
oil-burner repairman.
fact,
In
call
and formalize the complex-
too neat, too precise.
is
—
Between the two extremes
"vulgate" or the vernacular. level of
ities
uneducated
the
of
is
—
felicitous here.
to write to his
basement to gossip with the
our unpredictable
in
society,
we
might find that the repairman speaks beautiful English and reads Shakespeare on his weekends.
One
three "levels" instead of three:
could readily distinguish thirty-
below the "vulgate" one might
and the obscene, and one might also and formality. Furthermore, the classification is misleading because from it the
place the profane, the vulgar,
distinguish various important degrees of informality
student might infer that each level has
inappropriate on the other stock of each level
is
levels.
its
The
own
appropriate also at
exclusive vocabulary,
main word Such the other levels.
truth
is
that the
words as bread, meat, mother, church, prayer, dress, work, sleep, and thousands of others are the property of all people speaking English at any
level.
And
finally the classification
because
it
to stress
unduly the differences among
You must understand scientists
new
is
unfortunate
tends to obscure the basic unity of standard English and
in
other
fields,
its
varieties.
that serious students of our language, Hke
new ideas, The "levels of usage" forOne should speak of "levels" as
are constantly propounding
hypotheses and generalizations.
mula has been recendy modified. "cultural levels" on the lower levels the language :
is
characterized
13
THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE by
carelessness, illiterate speech, excessive slang, profanity,
on the higher
sort of thing;
levels
we have
and that
the language of the
educated, characterized to some degree by care, precision, order,
and good taste. The newer formula is based not on culture but on functions, that is, differences due to place, situation, occasion, or purpose.^
Perhaps the most useful way for us
when
ous "occasions"
would be
what
ask ourselves just
to
author and the reader.
easy, friendly, or
up
as distant
know how
is
by
Is the author,
gesting a relation between himself
self
among
to discriminate
vari-
various "levels" of English are appropriate
and
happening between the his choice of
words, sug-
his reader that is intimate,
he by a more formal use of language setting him-
is
from
his reader,
detached and impersonal?
We all
everyday conversation we can utter the same words ways and imply very different relations with the persons we are speaking to. For instance, we can say "Hello" in many We different ways with different meanings everyone understands. in
in different
can
stress the
second syllable
in such a
way
as to
!"
We
to see the other person.
—
— "Hel-/o —and can
mean,
indicate
we
stress the first syllable
"Oh
—
Lord, you again?"
are glad "//^/-lo"
We
can
even (using our eyebrows) say "Hel-lo-o-o" and mean "What a cute chick you are!" it is
ity,
This
is
a basic method by which interest or
boredom,
what
is
meant by tone
we demonstrate
of voice,
and
friendliness or hostil-
in the various occasions that confront us
every day.
Words tainly
written
on a page,
no eyebrows.
of course, have
is
cer-
addressing the reader, and the reader
who
is
It
often possible so to control one's
is
—and
Yet they carry tone too; they imply a relation
between the "voice" that being "spoken to."
cise relation
no sound
Let us consider two examples: employment
of language that a pre-
between speaker and addressee becomes absolutely defined.
You can often use words carefully enough so as to let your reader know whether you're being easy and informal with him, or formal and stiff; you can show him just where he stands with you. ^ John S. Kenyon, "Cultural Levels and Functional Varieties of English," College English, pp. 31-36, October, 1948.
14
OF USAGE AND FUNCTIONAL VARIETIES OF ENGLISH
LEVELS
These two sentences mean, more or their tone
utterly different.
is
In the
less,
first
same
the
addressed formally by a writer whose whole air
is
are being
very serious.
how
Notice the relatively long words he uses; notice
thing, but
we
sentence
carefully he
avoids the split infinitive, "to so control," in order not to sound
we
In the second sentence, however,
colloquial.
and the whole
the writer,
way
vocabulary and the
relation
is
are very close to
Notice the simple
informal.
the direct address in the second person
supports a conversational manner.
In
we may quote from
connection
this
1831, under the
printed as early as
title
a
little
"pocket book"
The Universal
Letter
Writer and Complete Correspondent, which expresses in a quaint but surprisingly
To
lay
modem manner
down any
particular rule for this sort of composition
patible with
its
speech, so
should resemble in
it
the doctrine of "functional va-
nature; but as a letter
is
its style,
is
incom-
nothing more than a substitute for as near as possible, the
language
we
should use in discourse. In commands, our language would naturally be concise without arrogance; in requests, pleasing without cringing; in supplication, tender,
much
out servility; in narration, plain without rich
moving, with-
embellishment; in description,
and glowing without exuberance; upon matters of importance, it should affliction, condoling; in mirth, light and jocose; in advice,
be dignified; in
serious without austerity.
The
style
must
responding, thus
adapted
also be
—among
friends
to the relative situation of the parties cor-
and equals,
it
would be
familiar; to our
superiors, respectful; to our inferiors, courteous; to the aged, reverential; to
and joyous.
the youthful, gay It
will be thus perceived that to lay
species of composition,
ideas on passions
is
— every
ner of expression.
impossible.
down any
particular style for this
be almost as variable as our
It will
different thought requiring a variation in the
Indeed,
it
must possess the
versatile
in adapting itself at all times, to all occasions, to all ages, ject.
It is
man-
powers of Alcibiades,
and
to every sub-
not to be restrained within any particular limits, and, therefore,
cannot be confined to one definite requires plainness
and
style; for,
simplicity, yet there
although, in general, is,
its
nature
perhaps, no species of com-
which all the various styles, from the most plain and unadorned most rich and embellished, can be used with more propriety than in
position in to the
epistolary correspondence.
15
THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE Let us see
EngHsh are guage
now what the and how they
differences in the varieties of standard affect
our choice of appropriate lan-
to use in various situations.
The
Standard English.
EngHsh For a tennis match
differences between varieties of
have often been explained by likening language
to clothes.
we put on our formal clothes; for we dress in sports clothes; for plowing com or driving a tractor we put on overalls or dungarees. Similarly, we suit our language formal occasions
and
to the occasion, to the subject,
far the
comparison
we
is
good.
to
our readers or
When we
listeners.
So
pause to analyze the anal-
word "formal," which to most people means "tails and white tie," a costume which millions of Americans have never worn, or perhaps never seen worn except ogy, however,
are trapped by the
by actors on a motion-picture or
television screen.
And
yet every
American home which can afford a radio set or a newspaper has been exposed daily to both written and spoken formal English. We must amend our analogy by a further definition of terms, by extending the range of "formal" clothes to include the well-pressed business suit.
It is
misleading to try to confine the main current
and lonely heights of formal and and scholarly language."^ The language which we call "formal" for want of a term with less unfortunate connotations It has is far from cold and lonely. warmth, strength, beauty, and an infinite range and variety. It is not confined to a few scientific and scholarly treatises. The great body of our literature, from Shakespeare down to the latest book on the international crisis, is written in formal English. It is the of our language to "the cold
highly specialized scientific
—
—
language of most books of botany, chemistry
—every
history,
sociology,
political
science,
textbook that you use in college.
It is
the language of the professions, such as law, medicine, teaching.
good part of all novels and commentaries. Most business letters are written in formal English. So are the news and editorial sections of many newspapers. As a matter of fact, a good share of the nation's private and public daily work is done It is the
and
language of
of poems,
and
all
serious essays, of a
of radio newscasts
with the help of formal English. ^Arthur G. Kennedy, Current English,
16
p. 17,
STANDARD ENGLISH What, then, are the distinguishing marks of standard English in more serious and dignified uses? First, the restrictions upon voIn contrast cabulary are so slight as to become almost negligible. to the incredibly vast riches of the "word hoard," as the AngloSaxons called it, the inappropriate or unacceptable words are few
its
indeed.
Slang and vulgarity, of course, are inappropriate.
In
modem
un-
more formal
situations,
most of the words which a
abridged dictionary labels as colloquial are inappropriate. is
a general feeling
among
students that formal English
There
demands
only "big" words, bookish words, words with a Latin ancestry.
That
The
not true.
is
much
simple, homely, everyday
words are as
a part of the vocabulary of formal English as the multi-
syllabic words.
Notice carefully, for instance, the words used in
each of the following excerpts
—
in
most of
these,
words actually
spoken on occasions as formal and solemn as any in the long and tragic history of
We
mankind.
the People of the United States, in
Order
to
form a more perfect
Union, establish Justice, insure domestic Tranquility, provide for the com-
mon
promote the general Welfare, and secure the Blessings of
defence,
Liberty to ourselves and our Posterity, do ordain and establish this
STITUTION And
for the
CON-
United States of America.
then one of the older men,
O
who agreed
with the king, arose and
man, in comparibanquet table in the wintertime, with your chiefs and your men about you, and a fire burned and the hall was warm, while outside it rained and snowed and stormed. There came a sparrow and swiftly flew through the hall. It came in through one door, and it flew out through the other. Now, so long as he is inside he is not cuffed by the winter's storm, but that is for only a moment, the twinkling of an eye, and at once again he goes from winter back into winter. So this life of man appears but for a moment. What went before it or what comes after it, we do not know. Therefore if this new teaching brings anything more certain or fitting, it deserves to be folspoke: "It seems to me,
son with that which
is
King, that this present
unknown
to us,
is
as
if
you
life
of
sat at the
lowed."
—From I
the Anglo-Saxon version of Bede's Ecclesiastical History.
went
to
the
woods because I wished to live deliberately, to front only life, and see if I could not learn what it had to teach,
the essential facts of
u
THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE when I came to die, discover that I had not lived. I did not wish what was not life, living is so dear; nor did I wish to practise resignation, unless it was quite necessary. I wanted to live deep and suck out all the marrow of life, to live so sturdily and Spartan-like as to put to rout all that was not life, to cut a broad swath and shave close, to drive life into a corner, and reduce it to its lowest terms, and, if it proved to be mean, why then to get the whole and genuine meanness of it, and publish its meanness to the world; or if it were sublime, to know it by experience, and be able to give a true account of it in my next excursion. For most men, it appears to me, are in a strange uncertainty about it, whether it is of the devil or of God, and have somewhat hastily concluded that it is the chief end of man here to "glorify God and enjoy Him forever." and
not,
to live
—From
Thoreau's Walden.
I see a
book kissed which
Testament, which teaches should do unto me,
I
me
suppose to be the Bible, or at least the
should do even so to them.
I
would
that all things whatsoever I It
teaches
me
New
that
men
further to
remember them that are in bonds as bound with them. I endeavored to act up to that instruction. I say I am yet too young to understand that God is any respecter of persons. as I I
did no wrong, but right.
forfeit
my
life
I
have done
Now,
in this slave country
whose
just enactments, I say, let
—From John Brown's
last
it
my
just
deemed necessary
is
my
by wicked,
cruel,
and un-
charity for
all,
him who
with firmness in the right
work we are
in, to
bind up
and which may achieve and cherish a peace among ourselves and with all nations.
widow and lasting
that I should
and mingle
speech.
gives us to see the right, let us finish the
and a
have done,
children and with the blood of millions
rights are disregarded
the nation's wounds, to care for for his
it
as I
His despised poor,
be done.
With malice towards none, with
God
if
in behalf of
for the furtherance of the ends of justice
blood further with the blood of
as
have interfered
I believe that to
have always freely admitted
his orphans, to
do
shall
have borne the
battle,
all
—From Lincoln's Second Inaugural Address. I
expect that the Battle of Britain
depends the survival of Christian
is
about to begin.
civilization.
Upon
it
Upon
this battle
depends
all
our
and the long continuity of our institutions and our Empire. The whole fury and might of the enemy must very soon be turned on us. Hitler knows that he will have to break us in this Island or lose the war. If we can stand up to him, all Europe may be free and the life of the world may move forward into broad, sunlit uplands. But if we fail, then the whole British
18
life,
a
STANDARD ENGLISH all that we have known and new Dark Age made more sinister,
world, including the United States, including
cared
will sink into the abyss of a
for,
and perhaps more protracted, by the
Empire and its Commonwealth say, "This was their finest hour."
British still
—Winston Churchill, From
1940.
Churchill.
I
work
a speech delivered to the
a thousand years,
House
of
the
if
men
will
Commons June
18,
Copyright 1941 by Winston
S.
Courtesy of G. P. Putnam's Sons.
in the
—
award was not made to me as a man but to my work agony and sweat of the human spirit, not for glory and
least of all for profit, but to create
something which did not It will
so bear ourselves that,
last for
Blood, Sweat, and Tears.
feel that this
life's
and
Let us
of perverted science.
lights
therefore brace ourselves to our duties,
out of the materials of the
exist before.
So
this
award
not be difficult to find a dedication for the
mensurate with the purpose and significance of
its
is
human
spirit
only mine in trust.
money
it comwould like
part of
But
origin.
I
do the same with the acclaim too, by using this moment as a pinnacle from which I might be listened to by young men and women already dedicated to the same anguish and travail, among whom is already that one who will some day stand here where I am standing. Our tragedy today is a general and universal physical fear so long sustained by now that we can even bear it. There are no longer problems of the spirit. There is only one question: when will I be blown up? Because of this, the young man or woman writing today has forgotten the problems of the human heart in conflict with itself which alone can make good writing because only that is worth writing about, worth the agony and the sweat. He must learn them again. He must teach himself that the basest of all to
things
is
no room
to be afraid; and, teaching himself that, forget
workshop
it
forever, leaving
and truths of the heart, the old universal truths lacking which any story is ephemeral and doomed love and honor and pity and pride and compassion and sacrifice. Until he does so he labors under a curse. He writes not of love but of lust, of defeats in which nobody loses anything of value, of victories without hope and worst of all without pity or compassion. His griefs grieve no universal bones, leaving no scars. He writes not of the heart but of the glands. Until he relearns these things he will write as though he stood among and watched the end of man. It is easy enough to say that man is immortal simply because he will endure; that when the last ding-dong of doom has clanged and faded from the last worthless rock hanging tideless in the last red and dying evening, that even then there will be one more sound: that of his puny inexhaustible voice, still talking. I refuse to accept this. I believe in his
for anything but the old verities
—
that
man
will not
cause he alone
merely endure: he will prevail.
among
He
is
immortal, not be-
creatures has an inexhaustible voice, but because he
19
THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE has a soul, a help
man
duty
endure by
is
to write
about these things.
lifting his heart,
it
The
poet's voice
can be one of the props, the
—William
Random
sacrifice
which have been the
need not merely be the record of man,
pillars to
Faulkner's Nobel Prize
by courtesy of
It is his privilege to
by reminding him of the courage and
honor and pride and compassion and pity and glory of his past.
The
capable of compassion and sacrifice and endurance.
spirit
poet's, the writer's,
Award
help him endure and prevail. speech, Dec. 10, 1950.
Reprinted
House, Inc.
In the second place, standard English on the more formal levels is
characterized by orderly structure.
munication of ideas pouring.
The
of ideas.
com-
Ideas are grouped and arranged in some logical seis a serious attempt to show As a consequence, paragraphs tend
There
quence.
expression and
a planned process, not a spontaneous out-
is
the interrelationship to
be more
fully de-
veloped than in informal writing; sentences acquire increased complexity as the thoughts they express
Third, those
who
become more mature.
use the language in formal situations, in the
serious discussion of serious ideas, tend, as a rule, to be relatively
toward matters of grammar and who write for a living, among those who write occasionally, and among those to whom a "talk" to be given before the Rotary Club or the Chamber of Commerce is an event conservative in
their
Among
those
usage.
attitude
is a tendency to appeal to an authority, to someone who knows what current usage is. The deference to "correct usage," in the sense of what other writers and speakers are doing, is strong among all users of the language. Grammarians may argue over the question of whether "It is me" is a solecism,
of magnitude, there
a peccadillo, a sign of
deadly
sins.
The busy
to the author of a
life
in the language, or
scientist
one of the seven
with a radio talk to prepare turns
handbook, or grammar, or Webster's
national Dictionary with the attitude, "I
know
make the language, but it is your business usage is. You are paid for that sort of thing."
don't
And
finally,
New
Inter-
that you people to find out
what
standard English in the more formal situations
generally tends toward an impersonal, objective attitude toward
the subject matter expressed
20
and communicated.
One must
not
STANDARD ENGLISH: INFORMAL assume that the exclusion of the writer's or speaker's
they are personal because
substance of what
sonal element
More
is
not
is
vital,
is
it
the personal element which
being said.
which you
however, are usually treated objectively.
term
examine the
English:
Informal
and
and
essays,
objectively.
Varieties.
Before
characteristics of "informal" English,
we
begin
we must
the statement that the essential unity of standard English
more important than the
difTerences
dis-
your various courses
will write in college for
are usually best treated impersonally
Standard
the
is
Subjects in which the per-
specifically, the sort of papers, reports,
cussions
a requi-
In most cases
formal writing are intensely personal in nature.
vital
self is
Indeed, some of the finest examples of
of the formal style.
site
VARIETIES
among
its
to
reaffirm is
varieties.
much One
does not stop writing formal English and begin writing informal
English as
if
he were stepping through a door from one
room
to
another.
In some writing traditionally labeled informal, as for instance in those informal essays that are written
with
skill
and good
taste,
the total extent of informality consists of the attitude of the writer
toward the
his material
and toward
same discriminating
same mature
difTerence ject
is
grammatical correctness and
structure as in the best formal writing.
that the writer frankly
through
find in
own
his
and
them
words, the same respect
taste in choice of
for present-day standards in
the
You may
his reader.
in usage,
The
only
freely interprets his sub-
personality or through his
own
likes
and
prejudices.
From the writing that is informal only in attitude one may move down the scale through a large variety of levels and gradations of informahty to writing that as slacks
is as unceremonious and unconventional and sweater and a corncob pipe. Much of the writing
that you will do in your college composition course will be informal in style
and
among
others,
in
attitude. all
of
In this classification can be included,
your autobiographical papers and sketches,
and attitudes and
sketches of persons
places, profiles, personal experiences, dis-
cussions of
likes
and
dislikes,
that you have read, your personal letters,
and
your reactions to books
and
talks before clubs
organizations.
21
THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE In the following specimen of the informal
words are chosen and arranged in order
notice
style,
how
the
dramatize a particularly
to
easy sort of speaking voice, a voice that implies an easy, familiar relation with
its listener.
do not mean to suggest that the nature writer is or always should be on mountain tops, either literally or figuratively. No one who actually
I
the
some fancy projected upon or read into her can some ultimate things-as-they-are, not some ideal of things-as-he-thinks-they-ought-to-be. There is in her what we call cruelty and also, even more conspicuously, what we call grotesqueness and what we call comedy. If she warns the so-called realist how limited his conception of reality is, she is no less likely to bring the sentimentalist looks at nature rather than at
ever
fail
to realize that she represents
back, literally, to earth.
How much given
man
of the cruelty, of the grotesqueness, or of the sublimity any
will see
depends no doubt to some considerable extent upon
own temperament and confess that
what
I see
I
suppose
it
is
most often and
marvel and, second, the comedy.
To
some indication most
relish the
of
first,
is,
be reminded that one
his
mine when
I
the intricate is
very
much
members of the animal kingdom is often funny though it is never, like being compared to a machine, merely humiliating. I do not too much mind being somewhat like a cat, a dog, or even an insect but I resent havlike other
ing
it
said that even
an electronic calculator
Not very long ago spiders in a web just
is
like
me.
was pointing out to a friend the courtship of two outside my door. Most people know that the male is often smaller than his mate and nearly everybody knows by now that the female of many species sometimes eats her husband. Both of these things were true of the common kind beside my door and the insignificant male was quite obviously torn between ardor and caution. He danced forward and then darted back. He approached now from one side and now from He would and he wouldn't. the other. My friend, no nature student and not much given to observing such creatures, was gratifyingly interested. Presently he could contain himself no I
longer.
"You know," he that
spider and
That,
I
a
said thoughtfully, "there
human
maintain, both
male. Is
The
and ought
is
spider to
only one difference between
knows
be as
it's
much
dangerous."
grist
for a nature
writer's mill as a sunset or a bird song.
— From
Wood Krutch. "Some Unsentimental Confessions of a NaNew York Herald Tribune Book Review, June 15, 1952. 1952 by the New York Herald Tribune. Reprinted by permis-
Joseph
ture Writer,"
Copyright
sion of the publisher.
22
STANDARD ENGLISH: INFORMAL The sion
following, too,
is
informal, the attitude of the writer
is
concern for quality
his
he says
A
written in the informal
clear
is
enough
in
is
VARIETIES
The
style.
occa-
obviously personal, but
what he
says
and
in
how
it.
publisher in Chicago has sent us a pocket calculating machine by which
we may
test our writing to see whether it was developed by General Motors, who, not
now dream
a Cadillac,
chine
(it is
satisfied
of
calculator
with giving the world
of bringing perfect understanding to
simply a celluloid card with a dial)
and shows four grades
Calculator
The
intelligible.
is
The ma-
men.
called the Reading-Ease
is
"reading ease"
—Very
Easy,
Easy,
You count your words and syllables, set the dial, and an indicator lets you know whether anybody is going to understand what you have written. An instruction book came with it, and after mastering the simple rules we lost no time in running a test on the instruction book itself, to see how that writer was doing. The poor fellow! His leadHard, and Very Hard.
Very Hard. on the face test Reading-Ease of written matter." There is, reading ease of written matter. There is the
ing essay, the one on the front cover, tested
Our next
"How
to
thing as
was
step
to study the first phrase
matter can be read, but that
of the calculator: of course, no such
which
ease with
a condition of the reader, not of the matter.
is
Thus the inventors and distributors of this calculator get off to a poor start, Hard instruction book and a slovenly phrase. Already they
with a Very
have one foot caught
Not only did
in the brier
cover, but inside the
how
to
book score badly on the front book he used the word "personalize" in an essay on
A man who likes the word "personalize" is we wonder whether he should be in the business
improve one's writing.
entitled to his choice, but of
patch of English usage.
the author of the instruction
"Whenever
giving advice to writers.
your writing by directing
possible,"
to the reader."
it
As
he wrote, "personalize
for us,
we would
as lief
Simonize our grandmother as personalize our writing. In the same envelope with the calculator, for writers
This,
too,
—a we
booklet called studied,
and
it
"How
to
we
received another training aid
Write Better," by Rudolph Flesch.
quickly demonstrated the broncolike ability^
throw whoever leaps cocksurely into the saddle. The language not only can toss a writer but knows a thousand tricks for of the English language to
more gay than the last. Dr. Flesch stayed in the saddle Under the heading "Think Before You Write," he
tossing him, each
only a
moment
wrote,
"The main
you
sitting
or two.
down
thing to consider
to write?"
And
is
your purpose in writing.
echo answered: Because,
sir,
Why it
is
are
more
comfortable than standing up.
Communication by the written word is a subtler {and more beautiful) and General Motors imagine. They contend that the
thing than Dr. Flesch
23
THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE "average reader"
capable of reading only what
is
writer should write at or below this level.
This
is
Easy, and that the presumptuous and de-
tests
a
no average reader, and to reach down toward this deny that each of us is on the way up, is ascending. ("Ascending," by the way, is a word Dr. Flesch advises writers to stay
There
grading idea.
mythical character
Too
away from.
is
is
to
unusual.)
our belief that no writer can improve his work until he discards the
It is
dulcet notion that the reader
not a trick of grammar.
feeble-minded, for writing
is
Ascent
an act of
is
at the heart of the matter.
is
A
faith,
country
whose writers are following a calculating machine downstairs is not ascending if you will pardon the expression and a writer who questions the capacity of the person at the other end of the line is not a writer at all, merely a schemer. The movies long ago decided that a wider communication could be achieved by a deliberate descent to a lower level, and they walked proudly down until they reached the cellar. Now they are groping
—
—
hoping
for the light switch,
We
to find the
way
out.
have studied Dr. Flesch's instructions
patience,
may
more confidence.
limits of I
my
may
the sense of
Run
.
.
.
asleep,
But
B.
it
will
expression
not wander far enough beyond the
Why
level
common
downward to our dullest The commonest sense
sense?
which they express by snoring."
that through your calculator!
out Easy.
—E.
men
my
return for
daily experience, so as to be adequate to the truth of
have been convinced.
perception always, and praise that as is
with more
"I fear chiefly," he wrote, "lest
not be extra-vagant enough,
narrow which
but we who wrote
diligently,
guidance in these matters to an earlier American,
It
may come
come out whole, and
it
White, "Calculating Machine," from
Corner, published by Harper
&
Brothers.
out Hard,
it
may come
will last forever.
The Second Tree from
the
Reprinted by permission of the
author and publishers.
What are the characteristics of "informal" standard One notices immediately that informal English is not the
English?
language
of the uneducated or the unintelligent, or of a lower social class if
there
still
are social classes.
It is
rather the English written
and
spoken by educated persons in situations where well-bred ease
more important than informal English.
No
dignity or high seriousness.
vocabulary of formal English
There
is,
is
part of the
excluded from the vocabulary of
in addition, a certain
freedom permis-
sible in the use of occasional colloquial or slang expressions. ple,
everyday words are perhaps more
scientific,
24
or technical terms.
is
common
than
Sim-
literary,
Contractions, Hke "they're," "can't,"
— THE VERNACULAR
more
"didn't," are used
freely.
It is
evident, however, that there
same conscientious regard for the conventions of corgrammar, in spelling, and in punctuation as in formal English. Sentences, too, are carefully built, and ideas are organized into paragraphs, although in some of the more journalistic types of informal writing both sentences and paragraphs may be in
is
it
the
rectness in
shorter.
The Vernacular.
There
is
a language below standard English
—much more accurately, there
is an endless variety of languages which the college student has only an academic interest. There have been times in the history of English, in the days before the radio, television, the airplane, the automobile, the daily newspaper and the weekly newsmagazine, a digest for every pocket, and an
in
education for every child,
when
rustics
English.
when
there
still
were
social "classes,"
spoke dialects and educated persons spoke literary
Now,
the specialized vocabularies of small groups, like
the language of jive, of the sub-debs, of racing, of airmen
and
marines, of various occupations, are made-to-order dialects of peo-
who when the
ple
usually
occasion
know standard demands
English well enough and use
it
it.
There have been many attempts to write entire books in the vernacular, notably Mark Twain's Adventures of Huckleberry Finn, James Stevens'
Brawnyman, Vincent McHugh's Caleb Cat-
lum's America, and, in a way, Sinclair Lewis's Babbitt, and the result
has usually been an illusion
remarked
—rather
Mark Twain make
—
"slightly
phony," as one
than a transcript of actual speech.
belongs to an older period, he was
his interpretation
of the vernacular of
artist
more
critic
Although
enough
to
than passing
importance. This place was a tolerable long, steep
hill
or ridge about forty foot high.
We
had a rough time getting to the top, the sides was so steep and the bushes so thick. We tramped and dumb around all over it, and by and by found a good big cavern in the rock, most up to the top on the side toward Illinois. The cavern was as big as two or three rooms bunched together, and Jim could stand up straight in there. We spread the blankets inside for a carpet, and eat our dinner there. We put all the other things handy at the back of the cavern. Pretty soon it .
.
.
25
THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE darkened up, and began
begun
thunder and lighten; so the birds was right about
to
and it rained like all fury, too, and I never was one of those regular summer storms. It would get so dark that it looked all blue-black outside, and lovely; and the rain would thrash along by so thick that the trees of! a little ways looked dim and spiderwebby; and here would come a blast of wind that would bend the trees down and turn up the pale underside of the leaves; and then a perfect ripper of a gust would follow along and set the branches to tossing their arms as if they was just wild; and next, when it was just about the bluest and blackest fst! it was as bright as glory, and you'd have a little glimpse of treetops a-plunging about away off yonder in the storm, hundreds it.
Directly
see
the
it
wind blow
to rain, It
so.
you could see before; dark as sin again in a second, and now you'd hear the thunder let go with an awful crash, and then go
of yards further than
rumbling, grumbling, tumbling,
down
the sky towards the underside of the
world, like rolling empty barrels downstairs
bounce a good
—From
deal,
Mark Twain, The Adventure
When
a skilled writer
slang, profanity,
produce an
to
genuineness.
—where
it's
long
and what a
effect,
The
sets
of
and they
as
"bad grammar," he does
it
perhaps, an impression of reality and
following scene
after three years in the
9.
out to color his writing by using
known
is
mood
Huckleberry Finn, Chapter
is
from a book that does use the
vernacular very well indeed, although the private
GI vocabulary
stairs
you know.
army
is
now
to civilian standards
first
class
who
patiently trying to trim his
might smile a
bit cynically at
restraint.
its
While the doctor and others worked on the bandages and the
splint for
the shattered arm, the medic with the pencil said:
"What "God,
"You
got you, Jack?" I
don't know.
It
was a
tank.
Where's the chaplain?"
don't need the chaplain. Jack," said the medic.
What
"You're going to be
There weren't any tanks around a while ago." "It was a grenade," said Jack, his hand still reaching for his face. "Where's the chaplain? God, why do you let me hurt like this?" "How old are you. Jack?" asked the medic persistently. He had already marked "grenade," because the wounds showed that. It had been a German potato-masher grenade, because the holes in his body looked like bullet wounds, but didn't go clear through him, and they weren't as jagged as shell or mortar fragment wounds. Evidently the German had sneaked up while the boy was down in his hole. Jack said he was twenty years old, he was a staff sergeant, and he was okay.
from Texas.
26
got you?
THE VERNACULAR The
questioning seemed heartless at this time, but there
answer,
If the patient is able to
it.
it
distracts
him from
the information isn't gained here, they have to get
it
a reason for
is
his pain;
and
if
back at the hospital.
Jack had guts. Of course he was scared. He knew he was hurt bad, and But when they told him he shouldn't a shock to anybody to get hit.
it's
reach for his face, he said okay a
little sleepily,
because the morphine was
taking effect.
"Hold a
the
flashlight,"
"The
doctor said to me.
lantern
isn't
strong
enough." I
grabbed a flashlight and held
on the boy while they worked on him.
it
I
thought, "Christ, twenty years old!" I felt like an old
I
looked at the holes which had riddled his right
severed his leg.
I
little
and
finger,
man
at twenty-three.
arm and
practically
looked at the swollen bloody gashes on his
I
looked at his horribly wounded face and head, and
how twenty minutes ago he was
sitting quietly in his hole
I
thought of
wondering how
soon he could get home. I
and and at
handed the flashlight to the medic who had finished filling out the slip, I went over to the litter and sat on it with my head between my knees tried to keep from being sick on the floor.
The medic took the flashlight without even a glance, and nobody looked me. They went right on working. Pretty soon Jack's face was fixed and
bad with a neat bandage and the blood washed off. His and it looked very neat indeed. He was wrapped up in blankets, and the ambulance came up and took him away. He was full of morphine and probably dreaming of home. it
didn't look so
arm was
fixed in a splint
"I don't I
know what we'd do without morphine,"
guess I looked a
mouth.
I
know what
don't
taken the flashlight turned to "It's
funny.
I
I
the doc said.
and white, and
was going me and said: I
to say,
I
started to
but the medic
my
open
who had
handle these guys every night, and some of them are
But
really in awful shape.
Jack and
foolish
little
last
night one
came
in not hurt half as
bad
as
did the same thing you did."
Another medic
said,
"We
keep some medicine
to
take
care of those
things."
—
They brought out a miracle a half-filled bottle of Pennsylvania Rye. I know damned well one of those guys got that bottle in a Christmas package, and I know he could have sold it for a hundred dollars cash any-
Now
Or he could have kept it to himself, and nobody would have blamed him. But we all had a slug of rye the doc with his bloody hands and his eyes which were bantering once more, and the medics who were kidding each other again. place between Florence and Bologna.
—
— From
Up
Front by
Bill
Mauldin.
Copyright 1945 by Henry Holt
&
Co.,
Inc.
27
THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE
Whether the following scene
illustrates the use of the
or merely a type of fractured English
debatable, but there
is
nothing debatable about the fact that the book
and worth reading
lightful
Naturally I
went
my
when
itself is
is
wholly de-
it.
engaged myself for marriage with Helena Gerbertovna
I
away with
right
for the fun of
vernacular
heartful of happiness to carry the
good news
to
friends.
Vactangi showed long horse Even Illarion, practically American himself now, didn't give me any support. Only Dzea shaked my hand and that sadly. "You take a big chance, Bijo, to marry with an American
But seemed
All he said.
girl."
"First
place," Vactangi pointed out,
Now
foreigner names.
him
you have
to
"American young
change yours.
One
ladies don't like
Russian, I
knew
immediately he married American young lady she made him go
well,
in court take the
bert
they weren't so pleased.
like
Challico sat dark blue in a corner.
face.
name
of Gerbert Goover.
Goover don't wins.
How
he
For honor.
feels then, that
Next election GerBe same
Russian fellow?
with you."
"Main
thing," Illarion said, "the
American
girls I
met
so far can only
cook out of books." "See.
Something
No
Ph-i-i-i-t-t.
else
eat.
you didn't know," Vactangi
"I can buy another book,"
"And
said.
"Lose the book.
You'll starve." I said.
what's more," Challico had his turn, "American cooking every day
just enough.
Two
peoples, two steaks.
Three peoples, three
cooking one extra piece for the pot's good luck. pected they gonna
sit
hungry.
You'll
die
steaks.
Company comes
Never unex-
from shame before you're
six
months married." "Yes," Vactangi said, "and after your funeral there won't be any table
Maybe a cup of tea for who carries your burial box. I won't come." "Never enjoy the pleasure at mealtime to call in strangers passing on the road to share your table." Challico shook his head. "Won't even be any use to get rich. You'll have a shiny five-hundred dollar, pull-a-button, push-a-button refrigerator and not one extra piece of baloney to keep ineither.
side."
"But you don't know the worst that's gonna happen in your house," "American young ladies all keep bodguts." "Helena Gerbertovna has dog," I said. "Irishman setter named Veleike
Vactangi warned.
Kneeaz.
Comes 'Duke'
in English.
But
that's all."
"Bodguts means writing down moneys before you spending," Vactangi explained. "Suppose you not feeling good, we take for example. You
28
THE STUDENT'S CHOICE want for
to stop In Russian
your stomach.
Fm
Club drink
You have
drinking
glass of vodka, eat piece herring
down
to write
..... .....
whiskys
Eating piece herring, too
"Where you ever knew American young lady tions?"
I
35^ IO4
to find out such Informa-
asked him. "If they promised to each other can't
"That's enough, boys," Dzea said.
Damage
help now.
Is
He
done."
shook
my hand
stood your friend twenty years, BIjo Goglo, and
— From
maybe,
In bodguts first:
I
again.
"Never mind,
I
don't stop now."
George and Helen Papashvlly, Anything Can Happen, Harper Reprinted by permission of the publisher.
&
Brothers, 1945.
A student of the
The Student's Choice.
know something and be
of
history,
its
The
It is still
realistic attitude in the face of is
by people of education, of opinions
I
value?"
It
is
a changing language.
changes in usage?
"What
to ask,
is
to
importance, people whose
not sensible, for instance, to use a double
know
past have used double negatives.
—
in-
What is the The comxmon-
being done at the present time
taste, of social
negative merely because you
pate future changes
will
been a history of
history of the language has
numerable changes. sense procedure
varieties, its resources
toward self-improvement
limitations, so that his attitude
realistic.
English language should
forms and
its
that
many
Neither
is
great writers in the it
sensible to antici-
be so progressive that you want to be on
welcome the future when it arrives. If you say, "Sir, I nobody nowhere; I think it was only me and him putting away the goods," your employer will rudely set you right. The standards of the educated must be your standards for the simple reason that you as a college graduate will live among and comthe spot to can't see
municate with those
What
who have
these standards are
these standards.
you can discover for yourself by wide
reading and by long and careful observation of the practices of
educated
men and women.
books, grammars,
usage
is.
Some
and
That
dictionaries
of these
men have
is
the
way
the authors of hand-
have found out what current spent a lifetime doing
but reading, checking, analyzing, and
filing
little else
examples of usage.
29
THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE
Of
course you do not have the time or the opportunity for this
you are
sort of individual research;
ment
of those
"who
do not give up
may
observation, for that
books that you read;
may
you
That
are paid to do that sort of thing."
reaUstic attitude, too, but
entirely
a
in the
men and women whom
prominent
hear on television, and always,
is
your research and
Observe current usage
be fun.
listen to
judg-
satisfied to defer to the
if
you are
in
doubt or
in
New ColNew World
a hurry, remember that a good dictionary, Hke Webster's
American College Dictionary, Webster's Dictionary, or the Thorndike-Bamhart Comprehensive Desk Dictionary, will provide a pretty good reflection of general usage. legiate,
the
In most of the papers that you
make a
conscious choice of
Many
view.
you by the
times,
it is
situation.
If
will
language, attitude, or point of
style,
true,
you
will write in college
your choices
will
be determined for
your instructor in history asks you to write
a discussion of the causes of revolutions, you will naturally decide to give him, not a slangy, breezy sketch, but a serious, well-planned,
and well-constructed to see that
essay in standard formal English.
any other decision
is
Similarly, a professional writer writing for the
the
New
Yorker
style;
To
returned to him.
Either he does this
that extent he has
choose the language, the
each
New
style,
hard
Yorker uses
a writer writing for Harper's uses a
appropriate for Harper's. is
It is
appropriate in such a situation.
and the
no
style
—
or his manuscript
But he does
choice.
structure appropriate for
situation.
Frequently you will have to decide between a formal and an informal treatment of a subject.
A
subject Hke
"Women
can be handled either with deep seriousness or with a with a humorous, touch.
It
light,
whom
you are writing.
Your
—you
final analysis,
who
and on the
choice, whatever
should always consider writing as communication.
merely writing
perhaps
depends on the particular phase of
the subject that you decide to use, on the situation,
reader for
Drivers"
You
it
is,
are not
someone to read. In the the reader, more than anything else,
are writing for
perhaps
it
is
determines the appropriateness of the choice of language,
point of view, and treatment that you make.
The
30
following books dealing with various aspects of the English
THE STUDENT'S CHOICE language
—
etc.
Harold
Allen,
growth,
its
vocabulary,
various levels of usage, the sources of
its
—may be found Readings
B.
New
Applied English Linguistics.
in
its
in almost ever\' college Hbrary:
York:
Appleton-Century-Crofts, 1958.
Language.
Bloomfield, Leonard.
M.
Bryant, Margaret
Modern
New
&
York: Henry Holt
Co., 1933.
New
English and Its Heritage.
York: The
Macmillan Co., 1949. Curme, George O. Syntax. Boston: D. C. Heath & Co., 1931. Evans, Bergen, and Cornelia Evans. A Dictionary of Contemporary American Usage.
W.
Fowler, H.
New York: Random House, 1957. A Dictionary of Modern English Usage.
New
York: Ox-
ford, 1926.
New
American English Grammar.
Fries, C. C.
York: D. Appleton-Cen-
tury Co., 1940.
The
.
Structure
of
English.
New
York:
&
Harcourt, Brace
Co.,
1952.
Gray,
Louis H.
Foundations of Language.
New
The Macmillan
York:
Co., 1939.
and George Lyman Kittredge. Words and Their New York: The Macmillan Co., 1901, 1923. Growth and Structure of the English Language, 9th ed.
Greenough, James
Ways
in
B.,
English Speech.
Jespersen, Otto.
Oxford: Blackwell, 1948.
Kennedy, Arthur. Current English. Boston: Ginn & Co., 1935. Krapp, George Philip. The English Language in America.
The Centun/
McKnight, George H. English Words and Their Background. D. Appleton & Co., 1923. Nicholson,
York:
New
York:
New
York:
Usage.
New
Co., 1925.
Margaret.
A
Dictionary
Oxford University
American-English
of
1957.
Press,
[Based
on
Fowler's
Modern
English Usage.] Pei,
The Story
Mario.
Philadelphia:
of English.
J.
Lippincott Co.,
B.
1952. Potter,
Simeon.
Our Language.
Harmondsworth, England
:
Penguin Books,
1950. Pyles,
Thomas.
Random Robertson,
Words
and
Ways
of
American
English.
New
York:
Modern
English.
New
York:
House, 1952.
Stuart.
The Development
of
Prentice-Hall, Inc., 1934.
Smith, Logan Pearsall.
Words and Idioms.
Boston: Houghton Mifflin Co.,
1925.
31
/
Chapter 2
THE SENTENCE /
GRAMMATICAL PATTERNS
A.
What
Is
Grammar?
Grammar,
as
we
use the term here,
is
a
and analysis of the facts of language as it is used today/ must remember, however, that the term "grammar" has meant
description
We
more things to more people than any panel of linguists on a TV program could untangle in hours of discussion. One may speak of historical grammar, comparative grammar, or descriptive grammar. In its more inclusive aspects it may mean the study of word forms, pronunciation, syntax, parts of speech, the past history of the language,
grammar, a
and
Our primary
so on.
interest here
of the scientific
grammarian.
the facts; then he tries to
A
formulate certain generalizations that he similarly, the facts of usage
alizations are based
Unfortunately,
and
Its
linguist,
In
the gener-
we use the definition of the scientific gramwe are up against a real problem. If we study it
becomes obvious that there can be no Everyone, from or bad grammar.
grammar
you wish, the definitions used by: Robert C. Pooley, Teaching 1957, pp. 104-107; Margaret M. Bryant, Modern English Heritage, 1949, p. 190; Charles F. Hockett, A Course in Modern if
Grammar,
Linguistics, 1958, p. 129.
32
calls laws. first;
on usage.
our definition carefully, Compare,
always come
if
such thing as good ^
methods
and gathers organize and analyze his facts, and
grammar,
English
descriptive
scientist first observes
finally to
marian or
is
label that explains not only itself but also the
WHAT
IS
GRAMMAR?
the college professor to the illiterate, speaks grammatically, for the
way each
words for communication
uses
complication arises
who
cluding perhaps most of those very important ones
mankind,
destinies of
do not believe
still
And
means good grammar.
still
The
grammar.
his
is
from the fact that most educated people,
that,
are
control the
them grammar
this; to
we
if
in-
realists, is
a "fact
we cannot brush away by a definition. grammarian or linguist makes a distinction between grammar and usage; the ordinary person does not. When of language" that
The
we
scientific
point out that certain speech patterns are inappropriate or un-
acceptable on formal or dignified occasions
a grammarian,
sons, that, to
of choice, of preference,
among
the educated
is
among educated
a question of usage.
a matter of what
and what
is
observe the distinction between
not.
In
book we shall try to knowing very
this
usage,
We
well that occasional confusions are inevitable.
we cannot by
terms, but
per-
a matter
socially acceptable
is
grammar and
It is
can define our
that act immediately change the
mind-
habits of everybody else.
we go on with a
Before
which
tence,
is
grammar
of the sen-
let us clear up another some time or other, question the value grammar as an aid to better writing. What
the concern of this chapter,
Most
problem.
discussion of the
students, at
of a
knowledge of
part
of
grammar
is
useful?
What
part
useless?
is
The
Many
swer must be different for every different person.
an-
people
and speak well without knowing much about grammar, but for those who by reading this book admit their capacity for self-improvement, grammar is both a convenient chest of tools and write well
a practical code of communication. that
it
ones.
enables It is
them
this clearer
by a few examples.
student correct a sentence like I,"
if
tions,
and
to repair faulty
a code or a technical vocabulary, understood by both
teacher and learner, necessary in learning
make
a chest of tools in
It is like
to build effective sentences
he does not
this,
"This
and
How,
teaching.
is strictly
between he and
know something about pronouns, about
and about the
uses of the objective
Let us
for instance, can a
case?
How
preposi-
can a
and clauses in a series the student does not know what phrases and clauses are? When
teacher explain the punctuation of phrases if
33
THE SENTENCE a person says, "I done pretty good in the
thought with absolute clearness
his
How
ways enough.
among educated if
there
The
is
least
terms
people,
—but
today," he expresses
clearness
itself is
person learn what
this
not
al-
acceptable
is
and how can a teacher help him learn
it,
not some understanding of verb forms in current usage?
we can
that
is
can
test
say in defense of a knowledge of grammatical usually well for teacher
is
it
same language. The Parts of Speech.
Words
and student
to speak the
are classified according to their
function or use in the sentence into what are called parts of speech.
Notice that in this system of classification
it
is
the use in the sen-
tence which always determines the part of speech to which a
The
belongs. tives,
word
parts of speech are nouns, verbs, pronouns, adjec-
adverbs, prepositions, conjunctions,
and
interjections.
If
you
wish to group these parts of speech according to their functions,
you
may
think of
them
as follows:
nouns and pronouns are nam-
ing words; verbs are asserting words; adjectives
and adverbs are
modifying words; prepositions and conjunctions are joining words; interjections are independents.
1.
A
noun
is
a
word
names something.
that
object, a person, a place, or a quality.
son, a place, or
names a
an object,
it
is
this
a
It
it is
called
may name an
noun names a
called a concrete
quality or a mental concept,
For the practical value of
When
per-
noun; when
it
an abstract noun.
information, see sections 22, 25,
Nouns are also classified as proper and common. A proper noun is the official name of some individual person, place, or object; a common noun names any one of a class or kind.
and
27.
Proper nouns are capitalized;
common nouns
are not.
See sec-
tion 8.
Between me and my friend what unfathomable distance! All mankind, like motes and insects, are between us. Thoreau. Petrified forests consist of trees which time and circumstance have changed
—
into stone.
On
the trip to Arizona,
the desert.
34
Gadsden ran
into trouble
when
his car stalled in
— THE PARTS OF SPEECH
A
2.
verb
word
a
is
being, or state of being.
group of words) that
(or
See sections 3 and
asserts action,
6.
The sun shines. It rained yesterday. The children did not go to school. They should have braved the weather. My aunt thinks that they are being spoiled. They will take the bus today. ^Ve shall be waiting for them at the corner.
A
3.
pronoun
nouns are tive,
and
is
a
word
that takes the place of a noun.
See section
indefinite.
4.
they, we, them, thee, thou.
Personal:
I,
Demonstrative:
this, that, these, those.
Relative:
who, which, what,
Interrogative:
who, which, what.
you, he, she,
one,
Indefinite:
none,
it,
Pro-
demonstrative, relative, interroga-
classified as personal,
that,
whoever, whatever, whichever.
some, any, anyone, anybody, some one, some-
body, no one, nobody, each,
everyone, everybody, either,
neither, both.
4.
noun
An
adjective
is
a word that modifies (describes or limits) a
probably most useful here to consider the and the possessive forms of nouns and pronouns, when used to modify nouns, as in the classification of adjectives. Pronouns have two forms of the possessive: the first form {my, our, or pronoun.
It is
articles a, an, the,
your, her,
his, its, their)
adjective; the second
when placed
form {mine,
before a
noun functions
ours, yours, his, hers,
its,
as
an
theirs)
functions as a pronoun. Adjective: It
was an eloquent, sharp,
ugly,
earthly
countenance.
His hands were
small and prehensile, with fingers knotted like a cord; and they were continually flickering in front of
him
in violent
and expressive pantomime.
R. L. Stevenson.
The
place
through which he
made
way
at leisure was one of those seem to crouch in odd corners musty treasures from the public eye in jealhis
receptacles for old and curious things which of this town,
and
ousy and distrust.
One
to hide their
—Dickens.
of our boys found your kitten
and noticed that
its
paw had been
hurt.
35
THE SENTENCE Pronoun: Yes, that kitten
welcome
are
An
5.
Is
Please
ours.
tell
that boy of yours that any friends of his
here.
adverb
clause, or a
a word that modifies a verb, an adjective, or
is
Occasionally an adverb will modify a phrase, a
another adverb.
Adverbs express the following
whole sentence.
rela-
manner, degree, affirmation or
tions in a sentence:
time, place,
negation, frequency.
See also section
5.
Time:
He
will
come tomorrow.
They
will soon
be here.
Leave your dog
outside.
May
now?
leave
I
Place:
Put
it
Come
down.
in.
Your son was
here.
Manner:
He
answered quickly.
played better yesterday.
I
She smiled happily.
Degree:
You
He
are very kind.
too good.
is
They
are rather dull.
Affirmation or negation:
Do
not go there.
Certainly, he will return.
Yes, he
is
No, you must
here.
not see him.
Frequency:
She
is
6.
A
preposition
noun or pronoun,
Many
sentence. for,
She called twice.
always pleasant.
from,
a
is
word used
called
its
It rains often.
to
object,
It
never snows.
show the relation between a and some other word in the
prepositions are single, short words:
at,
by, in,
off, on, up, above, after, around, before, behind, between,
There means of,
below, during, except, over, through, under, until, without.
number
are also a in front of,
7.
A
clauses.
of so-called "group" prepositions: by
on account
conjunction
is
of, in
place
of,
with respect
a word which connects words, phrases, or
Conjunctions are co-ordinating and subordinating.
junctions used in pairs are called correlatives.
36
to,
Con-
Adverbs used
as
THE VERBALS connectives, either co-ordinating or subordinating, are called con-
junctive adverbs.
The .
chief co-ordinating conjunctions are: and, for, but, or, nor,
both
yet, .
.
.
.
and, not only
.
At
nor.
.
.
but also, either
.
the present time, so
.
.
.
or,
neither
used as a co-ordinating con-
is
junction in loose, informal writing and in colloquial speech, but use should
Look up "so"
tion.
The
its
be avoided in most writing except in direct quota-
still
in section 44.
some
of the subordinating conjunctions:
if,
although, though, that, because, since, so that, in order that,
as,
following are
where, when.
unless, before, than,
Correlative conjunctions are: both also, either
.
,
or, neither
.
Some adverbs used before, less,
In
.
.
and, not only
.
.
.
.
.
but
nor.
.
as conjunctions are
Such connectives
after.
.
as
:
how, why, where, while,
however, therefore, neverthe-
hence, accordingly, are often classified as conjunctive adverbs.
modem
prose they are
There
sions.
is
no
commonly used
as transitional expres-
profit in quibbling over the question of
whether
they are transitions or conjunctive adverbs; the only important fact here
that in
is
modem
writing these expressions, with the exception
of hence, are not placed at the beginnings of clauses in
sentences.
They
are tucked
away
compound
neatly within the clauses.
See
14 for a discussion of the punctuation which should be
section
used with these transitional expressions.
8.
An
interjection
is
a word (or group of words) used as an
Note that an
exclamation expressing sudden or strong feeling. exclamation point tion.
For mild
The Verbals.
is
not the inevitable punctuation of an interjec-
interjections a
The
—are hybrid forms.
comma
or a period
is
sufficient.
—
verbals gerunds, participles, and infinitives They come from verbs and have some of the
forms and functions of verbs, but they serve primarily as other parts of speech.
They may have
modified by adverbs. verbals
is
One
tense forms,
and they may be
important thing to remember about
that they are not used to
make independent
statements.
37
THE SENTENCE
A gerund is a verbal used as a noun.
1
He
It is
as
its
tried
not easy.
is
is
the object of the verb
faster].
[Writing
is
the subject of the verb
It
is.
has
object.]
without
there
get
to
[Note that running
faster.
modified by the adverb
poem
Writing a
poem I
running
started
started.
breaking the
speed
[Object
laws.
of
the
preposition without.]
His
eligibility for office
was established by
having been so successful as
his
governor.
He was
proud of having won the cup. [Note the tense form of the gerund two sentences.]
in the last
2.
A
participle
is
a verbal used as an adjective.
also used as a part of a verb phrase, as in:
we
but
are here concerned primarily with
The
also such sentences as:
phrase in the
its
is,
of course,
reading a book;
Note
adjective use.
teacher was asking you a question, and
Teasing him was asking for trouble, the verb
It
He was
first
in
which asking
is
a part of
combination and a gerund in the
second.
The it
excited boy kicked at the barking dog.
after
Having
told us his story, he
he.
takes
It
Picking up a
stick,
he threw
Feeling safer, he started to walk home.
the frightened animal.
went
to bed.
[Note that having told modifies
an indirect object us and a direct object
story.
Observe
the different tense forms illustrated.]
3.
An
infinitive
which precedes
Mary wanted
to drive
may be The infinitive may
a verbal which
an adverb.
adjective, or
sign to,
is
it.
a car.
used as a noun, an
be recognized by
Occasionally the sign
Used
as a
noun object
is
its
omitted.
of wanted.
Note
its
object, car]
She had no car
to drive.
She was happy
To watch
We
to
[Used as an adjective
come with
us.
to
modify
car.]
[Modifies an adjective, happy]
her happiness was a pleasure.
did not dare
let
her drive.
[Note the omission of the sign
to.]
38 li
THE ELEMENTS OF THE SIMPLE SENTENCE
Exercises Exercise
Parts of Speech.
1,
In the following sentences
speech to which each word belongs.
You
elementary.
The
name
the part of
made
sentences are purposely
should have no difficulty with this exercise.
It
is
just
a preliminary workout.
2.
Tom Tom
3.
Wearily he implored the ceiling for inspiration and knowledge.
4.
Sandra,
5.
She knew that spiritual courage was important. Moreover, she had studied her lessons carefully.
1.
6. 7.
8.
9.
10.
and Sandra took wrote his name
who had
their examinations in the morning.
in a
heavy hand
at the top of the paper.
great fortitude, smiled sweetly at him.
Tom often depended on the impulse of A golden opportunity was undoubtedly
the
moment.
his.
Alas, he did not feel equal to the challenge.
With
Exercise
a sigh of resignation, he bent over his paper.
Identify the verbals in the following sentences.
Verbals.
2,
The
verbals are gerunds, participles, and infinitives. 1.
Going home is no fun; I hate saw the girls going home as
2.
I
3.
The
contract, signed, sealed,
to
do
it.
was coming in. and delivered, made me glad
I
to take over
the business. 4.
The crowd having been finally
5.
began
scattered by the embattled police, the streets
to look as usual.
He it
appeared to remember what he was supposed was another matter.
6.
Many
7.
Mother took my
to
be doing, but doing
people like going to church, but others seem to be indifTerent. protesting father to church to
watch two strangers being
married. 8.
Wishing
9.
Sitting in the next
10.
to avoid
Having bowed
an argument, Father pretended
pew were two
politely,
to be enjoying himself.
old and respected friends of his family.
he began to study the expressions on the faces
of the assembled guests.
The Elements of the Simple Sentence. Defined in terms of form or pattern, a sentence is a basic unit of language, a communication in words, having as its core at least one independent verb with is
its
subject.
It gives
the reader or hearer a feeling that
it
a relatively complete unit, capable of standing independently
or alone.
Now
this
may sound
a
bit
complicated, but
it
will
39
THE SENTENCE gradually clear
itself
up
as
of
the
you study the explanations and examples
below.
For a discussion
various verbless, subjectless,
mentary units that are acceptable to section
A
sentence
is
one which contains a single independent
simple sentence
noun or pronoun and
may have
as predicate
as subject
more than one
V
S
Men
or frag-
in speech, turn
1.
The simple clause.
and
in writing
Boys
m
are working.
S
more than one
verb.
ore wording girls
V
S
>
play
Boys and gids play.
S
V
S
V
Boys and gids laugh and shout.
1
—
.
Complements.
With certain and verb
complete expression.
a
types of verbs a third element
—
in addition to subject
is
essential to the
This element
There are three main kinds
of
is
called
complements
—
a
formation of
complement.
direct objects, in-
and subjective complements. Less common are the objective complement and the retained object. a. The direct object of a verb denotes that which is immediately direct objects,
acted upon.
V
S
O
Mary bought
V Read
V
a hat.
Mary
boughf
hai I
O book.
this
S
V
o
(You)
I
read
\
book
Did you hear him?
b.
The
the one to
40
indirect object names, without the use of the preposition,
whom or for whom the
action
is
done.
THE ELEMENTS OF THE SIMPLE SENTENCE Mother
He I
told
me
a
stor>'.
A/lof/ier
taught us a lesson.
s/ory
fo/c/ I
gave the dog a bath.
Note that when
to or jor are expressed, the substanti\'e following
becomes the object to
the
of the preposition, as in:
me; Dr. Jones taught mathematics man.
The
c.
or limits
subjective
complement
noun or pronoun, and a predicate See also section
Tom The
is
and describes
predicate substantive adjective
if
it
to
is
if
it
is
a
an adjective.
5.
a major now.
Tom
is
\
mo/or
price seems right.
The milk It
told a story
She gave a dollar
to us;
refers to the subject
It is often called the
it.
Mother
looks
d.
W
tastes sour.
good
The
to
They made him
their chairman.
e.
The
him
A
appoint, or the hke, refers to the direct object.
^,
i
They
foolish.
\
made // chairman ,
i
.
I \
»
.
hi
I
retained object
They were given some
He was
good
objective complement, used with verbs such as elect, call,
called
\
me.
choose, make,
They
looks
food.
is
used with a verb in the passive voice.
They
were given
|
food
taught a good lesson.
simple sentence
may have
adjectives, adverbs,
and phrases as
modifiers.
41
THE SENTENCE The
little
boy gave
his
mother a red
rose.
boy
gove
I
X In
Phrases.
2.
its
mofher
general, loose sense, a phrase
is
any group of
Thus we say that a man "phrases his thoughts" when he puts them into words, or that he expresses his ideas in "wellbalanced phrases" when his sentences are well-built or rhythmical. The word "phrase" in its general sense has its place in the language. In the study of grammar, however, the word refers to one words.
the verb phrase, the prepositional phrase, or the
of three kinds:
verbal phrase.
a.
A
prepositional phrase consists of a preposition,
and modifiers
of the phrase or
any of
its
object,
parts.
its
A prepositional phrase may be used as an adjective. The boy with boy.
the books under his
Within the phrase
is
arm
is
my
brother.
another phrase, under
his
[The phrase modifies arm, which modifies
books.]
She married a
The
man
of great wealth.
[The phrase modifies man.]
father of the child [adjective] watched
jrom the window watched
faiher
v. \
\i
\
child
\'.
A prepositional phrase may be He
[adverb].
plunged into the pool.
window
\*
used as an adverb.
[The phrase
is
an adverb of place or direction,
modifying plunged.]
For an hour he played in the water. [Both phrases modify played. first is an adverb of time, and the second is an adverb of place.] Francis was true to his word.
42
[The phrase
is
an adverb modifying
The
true.]
THE ELEMENTS OF THE SIMPLE SENTENCE Under
had
the bridge two tramps
built a fire.
tramps
had
\
built
\
fire
\
bridge
\% A prepositional The
phrase
best time for study
place for
it.
the second
The
is
[The
is
first
may
be used as a noun.
morning.
in the
phrase
On
the mantel
used as the subject of the verb would
best time for study
is
in the
would be
a
good
used as a noun subjective complement;
is
be.]
morning.
morning
X
time
t^^yb.
A
study
verbal phrase consists of a participle, a gerund, or an
infinitive
A
^X
and
its
complements and modifiers.
participial phrase consists of a participle,
its
complement,
has one, and any modifiers of the phrase or any of
used as an adjective. participial phrases
is
misuse results in a fier."
A
of practical \'alue to
if it
It
fault
known
is
of
any writer because their "dangling modi-
as the
of this see section 32.
The boy now playing center The participle is modified by noun
parts.
thorough understanding of the uses
stylistic
For a discussion
its
is
a
substitute.
the adverb now,
[The phrase modifies boy. and it has for its object the
center.]
Frightened by the sudden noise, the deer plunged into the brush.
[The
phrase modifies deer.]
His face, freshly scrubbed, shone in the morning
light.
[The phrase modifies
face.]
43
THE SENTENCE Having given him the
participial
the required amount, I left the store.
phrase
there
another
is
participle,
[Notice that within required,
modifying
amount.] left
1
V'">'^
A
W""^^
him
of a substantive followed
from the usual single
word
by a
participial phrase in that
it
grammatically
in the sentence;
An
element.
We
\
amounf
special kind of participial phrase, called the absolute phrase,
made up
is
given
V
store
1
absolute phrase cannot
participle.
it
is
differs
an independent
become a dangling
hunted toward the north, each taking one side
It
does not modify any
modifier.
of the ridge.
Their navy having been destroyed, they were forced to surrender.
The game
A one,
being over,
we
returned to our rooms.
gerund phrase consists of a gerund, its complement, if it has and any modifiers of the phrase or any of its parts. A gerund
phrase
is
always used as a noun.
Staying out late at night will not help your reputation. is
Harry enjoyed mowing the lawn.
You can I
as
[The gerund phrase
used as the subject of the verb will help.]
should
[Object of the verb.]
get the address by stopping at our house. call that violating the spirit of
an objective complement referring
[Object of preposition.]
our agreement.
[The phrase
to that^^
Hearing that song brings back sad memories
to
me.
song
IV 44
%. brings
memories
is
used
THE ELEMENTS OF THE SIMPLE SENTENCE Man.- objected to
my
telling the story.
ob/ecfed
tAary
sfory
.\n infinitive phrase, like other \-erbal phrases,
plement and modifiers.
assumed subject finitive
as
a
com-
it may have what is called the The assumed subject of the in-\n infiniti\-e phrase may be used
In addition
of the infinitive.
in the objective case.
is
may have
an adverb, an adjective, or a noun.
Tommy
did not stop to pick up his toys.
\\n adverb, modifying the verb
did stop.]
Their attempts
cut
to
the line
were
futile.
\\n adjective, modifying the
subject attempts.]
Whether
to
belieie
him
or to call
mother was a
real
problem
for
me.
[A
noun, used as the subject of the sentence.]
We knew
him
to
be the most hardened gambler of the regiment,
that the infinitive to be has
My
him
as
its
assumed
orders were to deliver the guns.
guns
deliver
am happy
to see
^
\
orJe
I
^'otice
subject.]
you again.
im
\^
happy you
45
THE SENTENCE She wanted me
•
to drive the car.
me
She
'!^
Y \
^or
;^
X.2
G
.
,
(J
3^2*-
344
£i
.
o F
pi"^
o ^M 5. oii •§ E
^9
^
-J
0~
^J= Q Siis,
a;'"
S-5
So M 0.5 2
>,
a-Xi
«
1
rt
I
60
c «>« .rtT3
M
rt
"^
j_i
—
o 5:5 « S-« H.S
>f
o o
.«o
E'o-:^-SsK?*^t-&ss«---g§
Prt^-S^-gcygly-B^g
=5
ASH 015 o 8
c^ 5 .- CM.1o
M 3 2 bc
.1
rtX«'Sc
^
Ji-=:.-
iOaj.i3 Or«0-*-**-00
I
oaao
o
•=*
KSrti^t;
-aS^
.-^^-.'-'cj
'5—,
"-w.Su
'^o-^SiE^
?i
y 3
©"""rt
H-a
^^3
.c
ou Quart
'-S:r
.1
2
I
^
I
I
St
£
c
•5
.2
S
i
«
345
23
WORDS AND
Exercise
2.
PHRASES
Look up each
Decide whether both
of the following words.
spellings are in use in your locality, or
whether one
is
more common than
the other.
honor, honour
sulfur,
theater, theatre
adviser, advisor
Exercise
Look up
3.
where the accent nunciation
is
pronunciation of the following words.
your dictionary,
in
Which pronunciation do you
way.
color, colour
night, nite
Notice
Where more than one protry pronouncing the word in each in your own conversation?
placed in each word.
is
listed
the
sulphur
use
acumen
decade
finance
aspirant
decadence
formidable
lamentable
combatant
despicable
gondola
preferable
culinary
exquisite
inquiry
superfluous
irreparable
APPROPRIATENESS 23.
The skilled writer uses words that are subject of his paper, with the occasion, is
of the papers that
your occasion
We
and with
the readers he
you write are formal some are informal. ;
you write a serious discussion of a serious subject, you should
use language that If
keeping with the
addressing.
Some
When
in
is
is
dignified
though not pretentious or
affected.
informal, you write in an informal, easy manner.
have mentioned before (Chapter
usage with manners or dress. styles of writing at his
Every
1), the
analogy of
levels of
intelligent person has different
command just as he has clothes appropriate You do not attend a formal dinner in
for different occasions.
sweater and slacks, or a football
game
in a tuxedo, unless
you are
determined to make a spectacular and probably unfavorable im-
and conventions in the use of language, just as there are conventions and decencies governing human intercourse everywhere else at a dinner table, at a football game, on a street corner, anywhere. A writer's good sense, wide awake to the situation around him, is his best rule of conduct. Here are a few examples of failure in appropriateness: pression.
There are
rules
—
346
23
APPROPRIATENESS Inappropriate in formal writing:
The
college selects
its
students on the basis of their demonstrated ability to
accomplish high-level academic work, their personal and social maturity,
and
it. [The "occasion" of this and the original phrasing was "potentiality growth and development."]
their potentiality for getting a lot out of
sentence
is
a college catalogue,
for further intellectual
The
and
social
was would keep
State Department's difficulty
for ensuring that the press
ment,
[remain
that
had failed to find any device on the new international agree-
it
mum
silent]
.
Inappropriate in informal writing: I certainly
hope you are having a good time
ing your potentiality for intellectual growth
the "occasion"
is
s.n
"getting a lot out of
He
told
23a,
me what
informal
letter,
at college this year
and
and development.
[This time
realiz-
and an appropriate phrasing would be
it."]
to
do and
I
accomplished the operation.
[I
did
The inappropriafe use of slang should be avoided
in
it]
serious
writing.
Slang has been defined as a kind of made-to-order language,
Some
characterized by extravagant or grotesque fancy or humor.
examples are hep, beat, savvy, take the rap, gripe, jalopy, snide,
baloney,
scram,
vamoose.
The
last
three
jive,
examples also
show what often happens to slang: it gets pretty corny, Webster's New World Dictionary points out that slang is "generally shortlived but may survive and become part of the colloquial or informal vocabulary." Slang is usually inappropriate in serious or formal writing, but some writers use it with telling efTects. Actually, most students are
less
college papers than
Hkely to get into trouble by using slang in
by using
stilted, general,
vague, and pompously
bookish words under the impression that a simple and direct style is
not good enough for important ideas.
23h,
A
mixture of the colloquial and the formal styles
inappropriate
in
is
usually
serious writing.
Most dictionaries use colloq. as a usage label for certain words and phrases. The editors of these dictionaries are careful to point out that the label implies no condemnation of the word or phrase.
347
23
WORDS AND
means informal, or
Colloquial style,
PHRASES characteristic of
as opposed to a formal,
a conversational
Now
literary style.
of course, as
everyone knows, there are thousands upon thousands of other words, not so labeled in any dictionary, that are also appropriate in conversation, in informal writing, in familiar letters, in all the
situations of everyday living in
which language
is
educated person uses colloquial English, and, what tant to
remember, he uses
it
correctly
if
he uses
it
used. is
Every
very impor-
appropriately.
In the writing of college students the importance of the problem of colloquialism has
been
some word or phrase
in his
through
it
question
his dictionary.
much
The
appropriateness.
its
overrated.
If
a student suspects
more formal papers, he can easily check If it is marked colloq. there, he should dictionary will usually supply
a formal equivalent.
Exercises Exercise
The
1.
a formal context.
The prime
1.
following sentences contain expressions inappropriate in
Revise each sentence.
minister explained patiently that the nations of the
West did
not ever scheme to gang up on the Soviet Union. 2.
He
3.
As the
lost
a fortune in the stock-market game. session
shake a 4. 5.
was nearing adjournment, the President asked Congress
to
leg.
When
Father spoke sternly to me, I found it wisest to make like a rabbit. There was a man who was obviously looking for trouble, but he was run in by the police before he could do any damage.
Exercise
Half of the following
2.
formal writing; half are not.
which are more appropriate 1.
The
girl
said
that she
would not run out 2.
3. 4.
5. 6. 7.
8.
italicized expressions are appropriate in
With
the
help of your dictionary, decide
in colloquial than in formal usage.
was driving
at
an excessive speed so that she
home. was irritated, he would take it out on his students. The dean was slightly under the weather. One of the boys was unruly, and the teacher gave him the works. I believe that he had had words with him before this. He was readmitted to class after he had promised to make good. After that the teacher made him work to beat the Dutch. No boy likes to eat his own words even if he knows he is wrong.
When
348
of gas before she reached
the professor
24
IDIOMS poor sportsmanship
It is
9.
10.
to
jump on
a
boy for every
Adults should not try to squelch a boy's
spirit
trifling offense.
and imagination.
IDIOMS
24a
Idiomatic English should be cultivated
in
preference to formal,
bookish English,
An
idiom
may be
an expression peculiar
is
(it is
How
grammatical.
who
is
to a language.
An
idiom
not always so) irrational, untranslatable, even un-
can one,
literally,
beside himself with anxiety?
pick a quarrel with a person
How
can one translate
"How
do you do?" into French or German?
Because idioms are created
out of the day-to-day living of ordinary
men and women,
They
themselves alive, pungent, racy.
But
language.
it
is
said, that idiomatic
Many
they are
are truly the heart of the
highly misleading to say, as has often been
speech
is
that used by cultivated Englishmen.
idioms border on slang;
many
now
of the idioms
accepted
were roundly denounced by cultivated
as part of the language
but squeamish English gentlemen of a former day.
You must not itself
with a few
think that the study of English idiom concerns illogical
phrases like those just mentioned, or with
a score or so of verbs that must always be used with certain prepoVizetelly
sitions. list
and De Bekker
the English language.
you
if
in
Idioms and Idiomatic Phrases
You cannot memorize
498 pages of idioms.
all
the idioms in
Idiomatic speech will come naturally to
you have grown up with the language;
if
you haven't, you
have something of a problem on your hands.
Many
idiomatic phrases have
—
everyday living
and
so on.
grown up around
to go, to do, to catch, to get, to
Notice the following examples.
Some
more appropriate in speech and informal appropriate on all occasions.
are
To The
the verbs of
make,
to take,
of these phrases
writing; others are
catch:
pile of rags
caught
fire,
[ignited]
[be punished]
You'll catch
it!
They caught
sight of a plane,
[saw]
349
24 I
WORDS AND
To
do:
am
done
PHRASES
[vanquished, ruined]
for.
We
shall
He
did himself proud,
do away with poverty,
[abolish]
[distinguished]
To make: She made faces
He made He made He made I
at
free with
good,
her mother,
my
money,
[succeeded]
with the jewels,
off
cannot make out what he
Please
make
sure of
Webster's
it.
New
matic phrases.
Here
[grimaced]
[squandered]
is
[escaped]
[understand]
.saying,
[be certain]
International
The
desk-size
lists
a very large
dictionaries
list
number
fewer,
a comparison of what three of the dictionaries
is
of idio-
of course. list
under
hang:
WNWD hang hang hang hang hang hang hang
24b,
WNCD
ACD
hang fire hang together hang out hang up
around fire it
on
hang hang hang hang hang
out
back in the balance
out together
up
together
up
Observe the idiomatic use of prepositions after and nouns.
certain verbs,
participles, adjectives,
The
following
will not take the place of
It will serve
tionary.
guard.
list
merely as a check
list
an unabridged dicto put you on your
Consult the dictionary for more complete information.
abstain from
agree to (a thing)
accede to
agree with (a person)
acquiesce in
agreeable to
acquit of
angry at (a thing)
addicted to
angry with (a person)
adept in
averse to
adhere to
capable of
350
IDIOMS characteristic of
Identical with
compare to (for illustration) compare with (to examine qualities)
independent of
concern in (be interested)
initiate into
from
infer
concerned for (troubled)
inseparable from
concerned with (involved)
jealous of
concur in (an opinion)
obedient to
concur with (a person)
oblivious of
desire for
preparatory to
desirous of
prerequisite to
from
desist
prior to
devoid of
proficient In
differ
about
profit
differ
from (things)
prohibit from
differ
with (a person)
protest against
different
from
by
reason with
disagree with
regret for
repugnant
disdain for
from
dissent
24
to
sensitive to
distaste for
separate from
empty
substitute for
of
envious of
superior to
expert in
sympathize with
foreign to
tamper with
guard against
unmindful of
hint at
vie with
Exercises Exercise
1.
In your desk dictionary find the idioms
of the following words.
You
type, usually after the synonyms.
Try
discussion.
decide
to
listed
under several
will find idiomatic phrases printed in boldface
Bring to
why some
number of these for class marked colloq. and some are
class a
are
without a label. eat
go
head
mouth
foot
hand
heart
pick
take
get
have
horse
run
word
Exercise
2.
Supply the idiomatic preposition
in
the
stand
space indicated by
parentheses In each of the following sentences. 1.
When
2.
I
3.
It Is
must
who can
she smiles, differ
(
)
you
in
be angry
my
(
)
her?
interpretation of this poem.
obvious that Mother was concerned
(
)
our safety.
351
25
WORDS AND
4.
Surely he will profit
5.
Tonight the Bears
Exercise 3.
PHRASES (
)
will vie
your advice. )
(
the
Gophers
for
place.
first
Point out and correct the errors in idiom in the following
sentences.
4.
He was acquitted from the charge of nepotism. There is no substitute to victory. She is adept about misinterpreting whatever you My aunt had become sensitive against drafts and
5.
The new
1.
2. 3.
refrigerator
is
much
say.
noises.
superior than the old one.
CONCRETENESS The concrete or specific or homely
25,
the reader's imagination than
word is more
likely to
touch
abstract or general or bookish
its
counterpart.
General words name
classes or
groups; specific words
name
the
individual objects, actions, or qualities which compose the group.
The terms chair
are to
more
is
Weapon
is
some extent
relative: furniture
is
a class of things;
than furniture, more general than armchair.
specific
When
a general noun.
you
say,
"She assaulted him
with a deadly weapon," just what control do you have over what goes on in your reader's mind?
What
picture do your words call
Did she stab him with a hatpin, club him with a brass book him with a safety razor blade that she had picked out of her sewing basket, or shoot him with a 22 target pistol? You say that the police found an ornament that she had dropped in the scuffle. It was probably a piece of jewelry which is more specific than "ornament" but it would have been more specific and more up?
end, slash
—
—
effective to say
The are
all
eral;
"a green jade earring."
verb move
more
when you
general; stride, amble, creep, glide,
is
specific
ways
try to
of moving.
make
it
more
The
specific,
fly,
adjective large
is
you discover that
lope
gendif-
ferent varieties of largeness are associated with different nouns.
For instance, bulky, towering, brawny, monstrous, hulking are applicable to which of these child, a
352
room?
—a
fat,
spacious,
building, a
man, a
25
CONCRETENESS
A
concrete
any of the
noun names something
senses,
name
Abstract words
clatter.
that can be perceived through
such as pencil, robin, cloud, smoke, shoe, ideas,
detached from any particular thing bearing those beauty,
empiricism,
whiteness,
truth,
devotion,
hair,
more or
or quahties,
less
as
qualities,
weariness.
Now
of course you can seldom give a concrete equivalent of an abstract
word, but you can
—and
To
abstraction that you use.
easygoing"
is
should
—
spell
out your concept of the
say "Father
is
both stubborn and
not enough; bring him out on the stage for us to
and show him in a typical action. Homely words are those associated with
the objects
and
see,
activities
of everyday Uving; bookish words are those associated with Uter-
ary formality.
The
following pairs of words
and
expressions will help to
make
the distinctions clearer:
General words
Specific words
An
armchair, a smock, a carving
knife,
frying
a
pan,
murder,
a
welder, a violet, our old black cat
Furniture, apparel, cutlery, kitchen utensil,
crime,
an
industrial
Abstract words
Concrete words
She served him like a dog; my mother hummed a lullaby; a splinter of shrapnel ripped open his right
a
worker, a flower, an animal
The the
faithfulness
harmony
of
an
of music,
animal,
a misfor-
tune of battle, extreme intoxication
arm; he was drunk as a
lord
Bookish words
Homely words Marriage, a bed, breakfast,
our church, a to
lie,
my
son,
to eat, to dig,
plow
Matrimony, a couch, the matutimeal, a male descendant, a
nal
religious
organization,
prevarica-
tion, to devour, to delve, to culti-
vate
Let us hasten to say at entific classifications of all
this point that these are
words
in the language.
by no means
We
sci-
arc merely
picking out handfuls of words as samples, and saying in effect:
353
25
WORDS AND PHRASES
"Look
at these.
This type seems to do something more to your
Abstract and general words are not bad words; they are necessary for the expression of abstract quaUties and general ideas. But in the writing of the average student abstract and general words are used too often where concrete and specific words would do a better job.
imagination than that one."
The
following examples will help to
make
the idea clearer
General and ineffective:
The
inconvenience of taking a bath in these old English homes
is
hard
to
realize.
Concrete and
specific:
I do not mind taking sectional baths with two pints of water in the country, where it seems unexceptional and goes along with fresh air, old clothes and being sleepy by nine o'clock in the evening. But segmented bathing in this weary, constricted, suburban household has nothing of rural simplicity about it, only skimpiness and inadequacy, and it makes you feel when you
finish
a postage stamp that has been licked and then not used.
like
—Margaret
Halsey,
With Malice Toward Some, Simon
&
Schuster 1938.
Reprinted by permission of the publisher.
General and
effective:
When we
returned to America,
and smells
of springtime.
we found renewed
pleasure in the sights
Concrete and specific:
From out of war, from out of death, we three came home to the North American continent. Here in spring we watched the yellow and the purple crocuses appear, the purple polyanthus and violets, the pussy willows, plum blossoms, and forsythia. The trees that were dead swelled with life, and the plants that had withered turned green. The rain smelled of new life, and new earth; death and decay seemed far removed.
—Agnes
Newton Keith, Three Came Home. Copyright 1946, 1947 by Agnes Newton Keith. Courtesy of Little, Brown & Company and the Atlantic Monthly Press.
Ineffective:
He removed
354
his shoes
and walked more comfortably
in his
bare
feet.
25
CONCRETENESS More
He
vivid:
leaned
the other.
down and untied the laces, slipped off first one shoe and And he worked his damp feet comfortably in the hot dry
until little spurts of feet tightened
it
came up between
his toes,
and
until the skin
then dust
on
his
with dryness.
—^John Steinbeck, The Grapes
of
Wrath.
Ineffective:
We
drove happily through the countryside, admiring the beautiful scenery
along the road.
More
vivid:
As the
and
horse's back rose
countryside
slipped
mansion with
past
fell
gently, like a ship,
—misted
woods,
glimpses
between the of
shafts, the
park land,
a
grey
chimneys, terraces and glasshouses, amongst the steam-
tall
ing trees.
—A.
J.
The Green
Cronin,
Years.
Ineffective:
We
noticed a
More
a chair and crying.
girl sitting in
vivid:
She was
sitting
deep down
together, while her
in the chair,
head was
a handkerchief to her eyes.
with her knees high up and pressed
down on her lap and her two hands held And her body heaved spasmodically as she
cast
sobbed.
—Liam O'Flaherty, Spring Sowing. General and vague:
The
repulsiveness of the
man
body and features and the Specific
On
A
of
most.
I
noted the fatness of his
first
time directly at him
I
experienced a feeling of
figure inclined to corpulence, dressed with care,
—
remarkable only
and then what a head! It was large, and had a copious limp hair combed back from the high forehead hair of a disagree-
above the neck
mop
me
and concrete:
gazing for the
nausea.
impressed
oily quality of his gestures.
able blonde
tint,
to the shoulders.
—
dutch-cut behind, falling over the pinkish soft neck almost
In his pianist's or
artist's hair,
which shook en masse w hen
355
25
WORDS AND
PHRASES
owner walked, two large and outstanding and altogether brutal white The face, a cross between Greek and Jew, had a Reynard expression, something distinctly wily and perfectly disagreeable. And equally with the hair blonde moustache or rather moustachios projectingly important waved beneath the prominent nostrils, and served to partially conceal the pallid mouth, weak and large, whose lips assumed from time to time a smile which had something almost foetal about it. Over the even weaker chin was disposed a blonde goatee. The cheeks were the
ears tried to hide themselves.
—
—
The
fatty.
continually perspiring forehead exhibited innumerable pinkish
In conversing with a companion
pockmarks.
this
being emitted a disgusting
He wore a pair of which he smoothed time. He was speaking low and effortless French, comthe developing ideas which issued fluently from his
smoothness, his very gestures were oily like his skin. bloated wristless hands, the knuckles the air from time to pletely
absorbed
in
lost
in fat, with
About him there clung an aura of cringing. His hair, whiskers and neck looked as if they were trick neck, whiskers and hair, as if they might at any moment suddenly disintegrate, as if the smoothness of his eloquence alone kept them in place. moustachios.
—E.
E.
Cummings, The Enormous Room.
Copyright renewed E. E.
Cum-
mings, 1949.
Exercises Exercise
1.
Find several
specific
words
for
each of the following general
words.
animal
grass
tree
vehicle
ship
bird
flower
to
building
road
furniture
to clean
Exercise
2.
to play
laugh
to hit
to fasten
Construct sentences in which you give concrete examples of
each of the following abstract terms.
Exercise
stubbornness
thoroughness
dullness
efficiency
fear
humility
3.
Rewrite the following sentences, making them more specific
and concrete. 1.
Two
2.
In front of the theater a long line waited for the ticket
3.
The The professor became irritated by the questions. The sounds at midnight are interesting to hear.
4. 5.
356
high-school girls were studying in their room.
little
boy had been playing in the back yard.
window
to open.
26
CONCISENESS
CONCISENESS Avoid
26,
more words than are necessary
using
adequate
for the
expression of your thought
The and
stylistic
been a concern of writers
fault of wordiness has
many
rhetoricians for
by many names
—
centuries.
Wordiness has been called
verbosity, pleonasm, redundancy, prolixity, dif-
By whatever name, wordimore words than you need in a partic-
fuseness, circumlocution, periphrasis.
ness simply
means
the use of
To
ular situation.
achieve the goal of conciseness, the student
must ask himself whether every word he writes is doing its work, carrying its proper load of meaning, and helping its neighbors with their loads. Busy editorial officers have a favorite phrase: "Boil
it
down !"
may
This
be an unconscious metaphor borrowed
from the process of boiling down maple sugar. use this metaphor as a helpful
ing
still
watery and
have you "boiled
Do
it
flat, like
down"
way
Perhaps you can
to self-criticism.
your writ-
Is
Or
the sap fresh from a maple tree?
so that
what remains
not mistake brevity for conciseness.
A
is
pure sugar?
sentence
not con-
is
words necessary not only for the adequate expression of the idea but also for the effective communication of the idea cise if it lacks the
to the reader. ness.
with
Cutting out words will not always result in concise-
You may summarize The the Wind in five hundred
Brothers
Karamazov or Gone
words, but can you persuade
three million persons to read your five-hundred
word summary?
Cutting out words in a good essay might also cut out of qualities
which make
it
good
—
it
those
strength, variety, maturity, grace,
cleverness, even accuracy.
Study the difference pairs of sentences. clearer, stronger,
1.
Objects, on our integrity
of
in
the effect produced by the following
Notice that the
Our
first
although longer,
is
always
richer.
first
acquaintance with them, have that singleness and
impression
that
it
seems as
if
nothing could
stamped and riveted on the impressions of objects are the most lasting.
obliterate them, so firmly are they 2.
first,
and
destroy
or
brain.
357
26 1.
WORDS AND PHRASES
The
ant and the
ones
lie
moth have
homes
night by night, from the corners of
homeless
—"I was a more
each of their young, but our
cells for
in festering heaps, in
and ye took me not in." young than are human
stranger,
careful about their
2.
Insects arc
1.
When we had done
there
all this,
erate evening; so that as
we
little
consume them like graves; and our streets, rises up the cry of the
that
fell
upon us
beings.
the beneficent and delib-
while together near the rakes,
sat a little
we
saw the valley more solemn and dim around us and all the trees and hedgerows quite still, and held by a complete silence. Hilaire Belloc. When we had finished, it was evening; so that we sat a little while near the rakes and looked out upon the quiet valley.
—
2.
Now
study the following
Do
sets of sentences.
you see what
is
meant by conciseness?
2.
Whenever anyone called Jim was always the first Whenever anyone called
1.
This
1.
spirit
had what it took. Jim had the spirit
to help him do some certain thing, and lend his help for the cause. help, Jim was always the first to volunteer.
someone
for
of co-operation
in order to get along
2.
for
to volunteer
is
essential
and necessary
with other people, and
of co-operation
which
is
this
is
necessary
for
anyone
to
a quality that
if
have
Jim
one wishes to get
along with people.
1.
Jim was one
of those people of
whom
there are few in this world like
him. 2.
There are few people
1.
Lumbering is placed in the upper ten industries in the United States from the standpoint of importance. Lumbering is one of the ten most important industries in the United
2.
like
Jim.
States.
This section will concern
which are
to be avoided
direct,
and
26a,
Repetition of the
A
word
tence.
358
itself
with several kinds of wordiness
by the writer who hopes to be concise,
to the point.
same
wore/.
carelessly repeated
Careless repetition
is
weakens the
effectiveness of a sen-
frequently associated with wordiness,
a
26
CONCISENESS
may
as
The
be seen in the following examples.
fault
may
be cor-
rected by using synonyms, by using pronouns, or by completely
rewriting the sentence. Poor: I
have been asked
troversy
among
on a subject that has been the subject of concommentators for years. That subject, as you have none other than the question of which is the most
to write
sports
probably guessed,
is
interesting, basketball or football.
Better: I
shall try to
determine which
is
more
interesting to
watch
—basketball
or
football.
Poor:
A
person
who
has seen each
game
game
for the first time
would probably prefer
game because this game comprehend and can be understood much more quickly. the
basketball
to
the
football
is
easy to
Better:
A
game
person seeing each
ball because of
its
The importance tract the writer
the reader.
It is
oratory,
as the
suggests,
and
time might prefer basketball to foot-
first
of avoiding
from the
and true device
tried
for the
greater simplicity.
it
dared, as
from
it
But the learning of
his
day would
did burn his dead body afterwards.
Phillips.
nation has been deeply stirred, stirred by a solemn passion, stirred by
and made an instrument of was
as scholars that
that
you return.
We
shall
seas
—
from Winston Churchill below
selection
the knowledge of wrong, of ideals
It
dis-
emphasis
for securing certain kinds of attention
Wycliffe was, no doubt, a learned man.
The
must not
used sparingly by most contemporary writers.
have burned him, had
—Wendell
repetition
perhaps especially appropriate in persuasion and
famous
it is
awkward
possibilities of repetition for
evil.
lost,
of
—Woodrow
you were here;
—George William
it is
government too often debauched AVilson.
to the feeling
and
life
of scholars
Curtis.
go on to the end, we shall fight in France, we shall fight on the and oceans, we shall fight with growing confidence and growing
359
26
WORDS AND
PHRASES
air, we shall defend our Island, whatever the cost may be, on the beaches, we shall fight on the landing grounds, we in the fields and in the streets, we shall fight in the hills; we shall
strength in the
we
shall fight
shall fight
never surrender, and even Island or a large part of
beyond the
if,
it
which
do not
I
armed and guarded by the
seas,
for a
were subjugated and
the struggle, until, in God's good time, the
and might,
steps forth to the rescue
—Winston
Churchill, Blood, Sweat,
moment
believe, this
Empire would carry on World, with all its power
starving, then our
British Fleet,
New
and the liberation of the
and Tears, G.
P.
old.
Putnam's Sons, 1941.
Reprinted by permission of the publisher.
The
efTectiveness of a sentence, or of a series of sentences,
may
be strengthened by repeating the same form of construction.
To is
differ
grotesque and eccentric.
is
incendiary and revolutionary.
Made drunk
To
protest
tions of a silly one.
life of
preposterous.
To
defy
with the freedom of ideas, college students should charge de-
world and
structively against all the institutions of a faulty
The
is
— George William Curtis.
Man
is
all
the conven-
— Bernard DeVoto. a long
surrounded by invisible
march through
the night,
foes,
tortured by weariness and pain, towards a goal that
few can hope
to reach,
and where
none may tarry long.
—Bertrand
Russell.
To make
parallels clearer,
junctions, articles,
When
he was
jor his
and
at the beach,
humid
such signal words as prepositions, con-
auxiliaries
may
be repeated
he longed
office in the city,
joT the sweltering crowds jor the hurried
They
left
on the subways, noonday snack at the drug
the world
as
wicked and
as ignorant as they
26h,
Repetition of
store.
found
it.
words with the same meaning
(tautology).
Wordy:
The
analysis
was thoroughly and wholly complete. and honest candor made
All the requirements of frank
360
his speech popular.
26
CONCISENESS The
fundamental
basic
essentials
of a
college
education are simply and
briefly these.
He woke up
at six a.m. this
morning.
The double that before a clause (pleonasm).
26c. Wordy: I
was very glad that when [Omit the second
in order.
I
came
in to the house that I
Roundabout expressions (circumlocufion or
26d,
found everything
that.]
periphrasis).
Wordy:
The
reason
[reason
why
I
was
—why—because]
was because she seemed so angry with me. was upset because she seemed so angry
so upset
[Revise: I
with me.]
26e.
Puffers.
A
college professor once prefaced the giving out of final exami-
nation questions with this story:
"I
ing marine animal, the squid, which
enemy
and
am
reminded of an
when
closely
interest-
pursued by an
manages to escape in the cloudy murk." The following samples illustrate what is meant by puffing up a simple idea by means of words. Despite the fact that one
releases a flood of ink
who can
it is still
bad
usually
write like this will often qualify for a political career,
writing.
Wordy:
Most people will agree, if they give the situation their careful consideration, that the commodity which is most plentiful in this world and which usually is
most thoughtlessly wasted
realm, or by whatever
It
name
has been observed by those
rivers,
and
so forth, that
the exact equivalent of currency, coin of the
is
it is
legal tender.
who
possess a
It is
Intensives
is
money.]
wide familiarity with streams,
water which presents a deceptive surface appearance
of placidity usually conceals a great depth.
26f.
[Time
and other
waters flow deep.]
modifiers.
a wise idea to question
and adverbs), because
[Still
it is
critically all modifiers
(adjectives
often here that wordiness gets a foot-
361
26
WORDS AND The
hold.
PHRASES "intensives"
so-called
cially likely to
much,
very,
etc.
—
are
espe-
weaken a sentence.
Wordy: I
was very much pleased when they told me they were so much [I was very pleased when they told me they were interested.]
certainly
interested.
He was
absolutely
impressively
and completely surprised by the very great size of the church. [He was astounded by the size of the
beautiful
beautiful church.]
Repetition of similar sounds.
26g.
The awkward
may
repetition of similar sounds in prose
seriously
your reader from what you are trying to communicate.
distract
Consider the
following warning on
the
subject,
and note the
examples Bad prose
is
bad
business, even
way
if
the badness be nothing worse than discord.
rhythms and inharmonious sounds will drag; as we read we resent something wrong, so that we hesitate, and look back to see where was the jar or the limp. E.g. "A more accommodating dcnommation is commonly given to it." Let the ear then have
its
as the phrases are conned; rougher
"Gratitude for his rectitude"; "an organisational centre of crystallisation"; "necessarily
temporary";
menced"; "the native
known he could
''very
rulers
at least
near/y entire/)^"; "so that
were as a
hold his own,"
rule," is
etc.
.
.
it
at
"Of
.
once comall
I
have
not only an untimely assonance
but imparts the alien rhythm of verse.
—From
Notes on the Composition of Scientific Papers, by Sir T. Clifford (London: Macmillan & Co., Ltd., 1923).
Allbutt, 3rd ed.
26h.
'Tine writing."
"Fine writing" writing. to
be
is
not,
as the phrase
It is flowery, artificial,
seems to indicate, good
overblown writing.
literary, the writer loads his style
with too
In an effort
many
adjectives
and adverbs, with big words, awkward repetitions of high-sounding (See also Section 27c.) phrases, and trite figures of speech. "Fine writing" is often the result of an over-complicated sentence structure. Its effect is a voice that sounds pompous and stuffy,
362
26
CONCISENESS and no
sensitive reader will listen to
such a voice for very long.
In exercise 2 below you will find five examples of "fine writing."
See what you can do with them.
Exercises Exercise
1.
In the following sentences, underline the awkward repetitions
and examples
Make
of wordiness.
the sentences
more
concise by cutting or
by other revision, 1.
There are many elements
problem.
the
in
Of
the element of politics.
all
One
of them, politics
elements
the
of
is
is
the most significant
element. 2.
We
were absolutely positive that
have said goodbye 3.
if
he had gone home that he would
first.
In regard to this check,
is
it
perfectly all right to endorse :hc check
on the back? Naturally the very large amount of time and
4.
wasted
by
students
college
and
money
that
virtually
is
amounts
undergraduates
to
a
very-
great deal indeed.
She had a
5.
set rule for
almost everything that she did and for anything
on which she had made up her mind
it
was very hard
to convince her
otherwise. 6.
The main reason for the domestic of money and financial troubles.
7.
Jones
and 8.
9.
is
troubles in
my
family
on account
is
chiefly interested in the line of mathematics, physics, chemistry,
etc.
My
grandmother she didn't think I should ought to study English. She had got along perfectly all right and she couldn't hardly read
a
word. 10. I
thought that
if
I
could not take chemistry that
I
would not have the
necessary prerequisites for pharmacology.
Exercise
2.
Simplify and strengthen the following sentences: espouse the
1.
At the tender age of fourteen he left his paternal hearth wandering life of the wayfarer over the briny deep.
2.
In the case of friendship, before a person can accomplish these other factors
that are
mentioned, he must commit himself
to
first
to
the right
point of view psychologically and mentally. 3.
The m.odem young
lass
of today
is
steadily ascending rung by rung to
rhe status formerly held by the sterner sex in the business world. 4.
After the war, youths
Mater
who had
to engage in strife
on
forsaken the shady walks of their
far-flung battlefields
Alma
around the world came
363
27
WORDS AND
PHRASES
trooping back to seek knowledge and wisdom in the cloistered seclusion of the campus. 5.
In recognition of the historical fruition of us should be proud to be citizens of,
doubt,
if
defend
it.
VIVIDNESS
A
27,
we were always
in a
it
state
which all of would help, without any readiness and preparation to
this great nation,
certainly
of
AND METAPHOR
writer should use words
and phrases
that give
life
and
freshness to his style.
There are of course dozens of ways to make a style "vivid." Some of them were discussed in previous sections under the head-
and "conciseness." In this section we consome other devices available to the writer who wishes to produce fresher, livelier language. Such a writer, first, should be aware of the possibilities for freshness in the various parts of ings of "concreteness"
sider
speech
—nouns,
modifiers,
aware of the
possibilities
Then he must
also
ularly since so
has
in
Second, the writer should be
figurative
language,
or metaphor.
be aware of the dangers of metaphor, partic-
much
lost its freshness.
lem
verbs.
figurative language has been used before
and
Finally, he must recognize the related prob-
of overused language generally:
the problem of triteness
and
cliches.
27a,
Use the parts of speech with awareness of possibilities for lively, specific
The
their different
language.
various parts of speech offer to the careful writer different
problems, different advantages and dangers, in achieving freshness.
Here we will consider very briefly some of the issues at stake when you use nouns, when you use adjectives and adverbs, and when you use verbs. 1. When you use nouns, obviously, a vivid style is more likely When you to be produced by specific than by general words. say, "I heard a bird singing," your words may call up a definite but you sense image in the mind of your reader or they may not
—
364
—
VIVIDNESS
do not know what that image
If instead of
is.
27
AND METAPHOR
"bird" you say
"meadow
lark" or "hermit thrush," your reader will at least
an
to
effort
meadow
the song of the
recall
Whenever you use a your reader's mind to create a thrush.
make
lark or the hermit
specific
noun, you make
specific
image.
it
easy for
You do more
than
suggest images by your words; you direct the picture-making that
goes on in your reader's brain. 2.
V/hen you use modifiers (adjectives and adverbs), you must
be aware of some special dangers. part of speech, generally speaking,
is
Ue down and You say, "That
likely to
die than a flat, uninspired adjective or adverb.
was a good
lecture,"
when you mean
that
it
was
witty, stimulating,
eloquent, instructive, entertaining, or informative. is
a nice
girl,"
generous,
when you mean
vivacious,
modest,
that she
is
big,
"She
say,
friendly, sympathetic,
What
conventional.
or
talented,
You
you find that are more vivid than pleasant, easy, hard? A book of synonyms will help you
adjectives can swell,
No
(See also section 26f.)
more
dull,
find
In the case of adverbs, note that often a weak verb-adverb
them.
group may be replaced more
effectively
Study
by a single verb.
the following examples:
He ran quickly. [He fled, sprinted, trotted, rushed, surged.] He was breathing rapidly. [He was panting, blowing, wheezing,
pufBng,
gasping.]
He
cut through
[He pierced
it.
it,
sliced
it,
tore
it
open, split
it,
ripped
it
open.]
He threw 3.
it
down
violently.
[He hurled
it,
flung
it,
heaved
it,
pitched
it.]
V/hen you use verbs, you should consider replacing genmore specific and de-
eral or abstract verbs with verbs that are scriptive.
He moved
Here are some examples: toward the door.
drifted, flitted
[He
crept,
crawled, strolled, sidled, inched,
toward the door.]
spoke several words. [He whispered, roared, shouted, hissed, mumbled, muttered several words.] We put it on the wagon. [We tossed, lifted, pitched, threw it on the
He
wagon.]
He
got on the horse.
[He scrambled, leaped, jumped, vaulted on the
horse.]
365
27
WORDS AND
PHRASES
Metaphors are an
27b,
essential technique for adding freshness to
language,
A as
metaphor, very simply,
were something
if it
says the poet, "that's
that his love
is
a device for talking about one thing
is
my
"Oh,
else.
newly sprung
love
not a red, red rose, and she
To
is
a red, red rose,"
like
Now we
all
know
only "like" a rose in
This suggests the delight and the
a very limited, qualified way.
danger of metaphor.
is
in June."
suggest a likeness, while at the
time defining the limit of that likeness,
is
same
the delicate process of
making a metaphor.
Many ness
people speak of a metaphor as a "simile"
directly expressed
is
The
ference.
language as
—
that
when
is,
point
it is
is
the like-
the connectives "like" or
Actually this distinction makes
"as" are used.
when
little
practical dif-
that metaphorical language, or figurative
often called, can appear in a
huge variety
of
ways
with vast differences in the effects produced. Similes:
The water
My
lay gray
and wrinkled
like
an elephant's
skin.
—Nancy Hale.
—Joseph Conrad. —Marby
very thoughts were like the ghostly rustle of dead leaves.
She barged
in with the children like a
bomber
escorted
fighters.
garet Halsey.
Sending
men
to that
army
is
like shoveling fleas across a
barnyard.
—Lincoln.
Here the wind took on a wild dignity lashing the island-dotted reaches Bay into waves that fled up the Hudson like a herd of gray horses with white manes swimming steadily in from the sea. Elizabeth Page. .
.
.
of the
.
.
.
—
Metaphors: Life
is
a tragedy wherein
our part in
it.
The burning
we
sit
as spectators for a while,
and then act out
—Jonathan Swift. geyser was sending out comrts of flame which were igniting
the dry fiber of the surrounding trees.
—Caroline Mytinger.
Figures of speech are frequently used for humor, as the following
examples
366
will
show:
VIVIDNESS
He had He was
a voice like a coyote with bronchitis.
up like a Christmas tree. Her mouth opened like a folding bed. She had a large Wagnerian mother with
27
AND METAPHOR
—O. Henry.
all lit
a voice that
would
shatter glass.
—From My Fair Lady. We
must be
careful, however, not to
pepper a writing
useful to the student
More
fear chiefly lest
it
home, where we can
at
see
how
they
my
may
expres.sion
may
not be extra-vagant enough,
not
enough beyond the narrow limits of my daily experience, so as be adequate to the truth of which I have been convinced. Extra vagance! depends on how you are yarded. The migrating buffalo, which seeks new
wander to
the observance of figures of speech in con-
into their surroundings.
fit
I
is
where they look more
text,
with
style
isolated figures of speech that are merely clever or cute.
far
pastures in another latitude,
is
not extravagant like the
cow which
over the pail, leaps the cowyard fence, and runs after her time.
I desire to
moment,
to
men
speak somewhere without bounds; in their
waking moments;
for I
like a
am
calf, in
man
in
kicks
milking
a waking
convinced that
can-
I
not exaggerate enough even to lay the foundation of a true expression.
— From Walden, by H. D. Thoreau. Then suddenly
the starlings attacked the tree behind which she had hidden.
In one flock they pelted
hummed
First published in 1849.
it
like
many winged
so
with the whizz they made, as
if
stones.
The whole
tree
each bird plucked a wire,
A
whizz, a buzz rose from the bird-buzzing, bird-vibrant, bird-blackened tree.
The
tree
became
a rhapsody, a quivering cacophony, a whizz and vibrant
rapture, branches, leaves, birds syllabling discordantly
measure, without stop devouring the
— From Between
tree.
Then
the Acts by Virginia Woolf.
up!
life,
Then
life,
life,
without
ofl'!
Copyright 1941 by Harcourt,
Brace and Company, Inc.
Then like
the creeping murderer, the octopus, steals out, slowly, softly,
a gray mist, pretending
lump
of decaying
meat while
now
to
its evil
be a bit of weed,
now
goat eyes watch coldly.
a rock, It
moving
now
a
oozes and
and as it comes close its yellow eyes bum and body turns rosy with the pulsing color of anticipation and rage. Then suddenly it runs lightly on the tips of its arms, as ferociously as a charging cat. It leaps savagely on the crab, there is a pufl" of black fluid, and the struggling mass is obscured in the sepia cloud while the octopus murders flows toward a feeding crab, its
367
27
WORDS AND PHRASES On
the crab.
the exposed rocks out of water, the barnacles bubble behind
their closed doors
—From
and the limpets dry
Cannery Row.
permission of
out.
Copyright 1945 by John Steinbeck.
The Viking
Reprinted by
Press, Inc.
was a street of uniform bald houses of four rooms and scullery. Its parwindows bayed out to the street, without the grace of one yard of green or the gentility of a gate. Some of the houses, at that time, in a spasm of discontent with their estate, had turned themselves into shops, and had made a bad job of it, being neither good shop nor honest house; but though it was
It
lour
down
it
cheery
Always there was the noise
grinned.
call of
of dogs
and
babies,
and the
neighbor to neighbor and the occult cries of coal-man, winkle-
man, milk-man, and balloon-and-flag man.
—Thomas
The Wind and
Burke,
Doran and Company,
27c,
Inc.
the Rain.
Copyright 1924 by Doubleday,
Reprinted by permission of the publishers.
Metaphors and other phrases that have become
trite
must be
avoided.
A that
made up
great deal of our everyday language
is
were
have become so famil-
originally figures of speech, but
iar to us that they
have become "dead"
—
that
is,
of phrases
they have
lost
and refer simply to single items of experience. Examples are touch and go, guidepost, halcyon days, beyond the pale. The originally metaphorical character of these words is pretty well lost, and there is no particular objection to their use if
their doubleness,
More dangerous
they are not overused.
are the metaphors that are "dying" slight doubleness of
—
that
for the writer, however, is,
they
still
retain
watered down and weakened by time that the phrases are to
some
meaning, but the doubleness has become so irritating
Examples are budding genius, the table groaned, fit money was burning a hole in my pocket. Such
a reader.
as a fiddle, the
uses of language are to be avoided
Many modem cliches in
writers
make
:
they are cliches.
ingenious use of the thousands of
our contemporary language for purposes of comedy or
irony or satire.
Here
is
a simple example by the humorist, S.
J.
Perelman takes a phrase like "burning a hole in my pocket" (a dying metaphor), and brings it back to life by pretend-
Perelman.
ing to take
368
it
literally.
:
AND METAPHOR
VIVIDNESS I
27
down Fifth Avenue the other afternoon when sevwhich had been burning a hole in my pocket suddenly burst flame and I found myself in Brentano's. By the time my pants had
was
strolling aimlessly
dollars
eral
into
stopped smoldering
I
discovered
I
owned
a
profusely
illustrated
set
of
Brantome's spicy "Lives of Fair and Gallant Ladies."
—
S.
Perelman, The Most of
J.
S. /.
Perelman.
Simon &
Schuster, Inc.,
1958.
This of course
moral
is
clear:
is
unless
a very special use of
not use phrases like "burning a hole in
A ing
full
treatment of cliches could
may
list
fill
my pocket." a big book.
But the follow-
clear as crystal
conspicuous by his absence
acid test
been said
course of true love
all in all
devouring element
work and no play a long-felt want
discreet silence
all
among
those present
arms of Morpheus as luck would have at a loss for words at one fell swoop
doomed to disappointment downy couch drastic action
ardent admirers
dull, sickening it
thud
each and every one easier said than
done
equal to the occasion
beat a hasty retreat
fair sex
beggars description
familiar landmark
better half
favor with a selection
better late than never
festive occasion
blissfully ignorant
few and
blushing bride
filthy lucre
bolt
from the blue
far
between
goes without saying
bountiful repast
great open spaces
breathless silence
gridiron warriors
briny deep
grim reaper
budding genius busy as a bee by leaps and bounds
hands across the sea holy bonds of matrimony
caught
The
help to put you on your guard
aching void
after all has
language.
trite
you know very well what you are doing, do
like rats in a trap
in all
its
glory
in the last analysis
checkered career
irony of fate
cheered to the echo
justice to the occasion
369
27 last
WORDS AND
PHRASES
but not least
riot of color
lonely sentinel
ripe old age
long-felt
want mantle of snow
sadder but wiser
meets the eye
silence reigned
method in his madness monarch of all he surveys mother nature motley crowd nipped in the bud
single blessedness
shadow
of the goal posts
supreme
specimen of humanity
sumptuous repast sweat of his brow sweet
girl
graduate
none the worse for his experience none the worse for wear no sooner said than done
vale of tears
table groaned tired but
happy
partake of refreshments
venture a suggestion
pleasing prospect
watery grave
powers that be
wee small hours wends his way where ignorance
presided at the piano
proud possessor psychological reigns
moment
bliss
is
with bated breath
supreme
words fail to express worked like a Trojan wrought havoc
rendered a selection replete with interest
Exercises Exercise
1.
statement." is
little
Here
a
is
short
The language
or no metaphor.
is
paragraph of what might be called "plain unembellished and not particularised; there
Rewrite
this
passage to
make
it
more
"vivid," by
giving attention to the parts of speech and to the possibilities for metaphor.
The boy walked home from
and he As he approached his own house, he paused to talk to his neighbor, who was putterFinally he turned and walked indoors, for he was ing about on his lawn. school very slowly.
It
was
April,
observed as he went the various signs of the spring season.
hungry. Exercise 2.
Now
dying metaphors, Exercise
3.
cliches.
Then
Exercise
4.
You
rewrite this passage again, this time using just as
cliches,
and
trite
Select a sports story
from a newspaper, and underline
Do
the
same
for a
news
one of the
370
its
story about the international situation.
difficulties
ing this operation arises from the fact that cliches,
all
translate the story into plain statement.
will observe that
many
many
phrases as you can.
you (and he) simply cannot
tell
you
may
when
encounter
a writer
what he
is
is
in
perform-
using a great
talking about.
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
SENTENCE UNITY The problem
of
unity in a sentence concerns
itself
primarily
with either "not enough" or "too much." 'G'
NOT ENOUGH 28a,
In
standard English, the structural unity of the written sentence
depends on the presence of a
The on
its
verb with
completeness or unity of a sentence structure.
As we
The
thought or content.
shall
see
later,
it
contrary,
it is
its
subject.
based, in one sense,
is
sentence, however,
On the
unchangeable pattern.
and
finite
is is
also
based on
its
not a formula or an
a unit of such variety
no rule, only the good sense of the writer, can enough" becomes "complete," and when "complete" becomes "too much." Obviously, a sentence is "not enough" when it is not grammatiflexibility that
decide
when
"not
cally complete; that
plied subject see section
and
is,
when
it
does not have an expressed or im-
For a discussion of sentence fragments
verb.
1.
TOO MUCH 28b,
may
be destroyed by the inclusion of words, phrases, or clauses that have no direct bearing on the Sentence unity
principal thought of the sentence,
A
sentence
may have
"too
much"
in several ways.
unrelated ideas of the same weight and importance
may
First,
two
be thrown
371
28
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
The proper cure for this The methods of subordination are Second, a sentence may appear bulging discussed in section 29. and baggy from having too many related minor details thrown make a compound
together to
sort of fault
into
tence
may
lated
minor
sentence.
subordination.
For the cure of
it.
was
is
this fault see section 28c.
lack unity because the writer tossed into detail
which happened
pop
to
into his
Finally, a senit some unremind while he
writing.
Unrelated details:
My
uncle, short of
temper and of breath, eighty years old
at this
weighing two hundred pounds, swore angrily at the tramp,
may be The
time and
[The swearing
related to "temper" but not clearly to his weight and his age.]
destructiveness of the termite,
instincts for social organization,
is
which
is
very great.
an
insect with almost
[The
human
relative clause has noth-
ing to do with the termite's ability to do harm.]
After the Spanish Civil War, free speech, which is guaranteed to every American by our Constitution, was suppressed by the Franco regime. [If this is about Spain, the reference to America is merely thrown in.] Unified:
My The
uncle, a short-tempered
man, swore angrily
destructiveness of the termite
After the Spanish Civil
War
is
at the tramp.
very great.
free speech in
Spain was suppressed by the
Franco regime.
28c.
Overloading a sentence with details obscures destroys
If
its
clearness
and
its
unity
and
order.
the details are important, they should be told in separate
sentences,
where they can be given proper value.
unimportant, they
may
If
they are
be omitted.
Confused: Military training teaches a person to stand up straight and walk with his
head up; this helps in future life because it becomes a habit and so many people have the bad habit of walking stooped and this leads to poor health and poor appearance.
372
28
SENTENCE UNITY common
Military science teaches also officers
but to everyone to
whom
your superior
courtesies, not only to
courtesy
is
due; for instance
when you
enter offices, or the courtesies you should use
when you
are using firearms
while hunting or shooting in the presence of another person.
you write sentences
If
the
time; say
as simply
it
your remedy
like these,
principles of thought
first
and
is
to
go back
communication: say one thing
clearly as
you can; say
it
so that
to
at a
can-
it
not be misundei"stood.
Let us try to dissect these sentences in order to discover what the writer tried to say. Revised: Military training teaches a person to stand erect and to walk with his head up.
is enough for one sentence.] Good posture [Is that what the meant by "this" and "it"?] becomes habitual. It leads directly to health and better appearance.
[That
writer better
Military science also teaches
common
For instance,
courtesy, not only to officers superior
[Are there some persons to
in rank but also to everyone.
teaches one
is
not due"?]
to
handle firearms with safety to others.
chosen that no sentence can
it
how
to enter
whom
an
"courtesy
office,
or
how
[These two examples are so badly
make them apt
or congruous.]
Exercises Exercise
1.
Determine which
of
the
following
are
sentence
fragments.
Correct them by supplying the missing elements.
1.
Being of sound mind and a ready
wit,
Belinda was occasionally accused
of being catty. 2.
Her sharp claws
in
their velvet sheath being harmless except in self-
defense. 3.
Giggling in delight, she read to them a
poem about
the adventures of
Mehitabel. 4.
The
natural
dignity
and
self-respect
of
cats
leading some
people to
think that cats are two-faced. 5.
The
only two-faced cat on record being sacred to the Egyptian goddess
Isis.
6.
our old black cat, came in late one morning, glanced Belinda out of his good eye, and looked about for his favorite chair.
Arbutus,
at
373
29
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
7.
His other eye having been temporarily closed during a fearful encounter
8.
The
in the night.
astonishing thing being, as Belinda observed, that cats should have
two holes cut
in their coats exactly at the places
Having dislodged me from
9.
his favorite chair,
where
their eyes were.
Arbutus was soon snoring
happily.
Before drifting
10.
"Wake me up
Exercise tails
1.
off into oblivion,
he opened his good eye and murmured,
in time for his funeral, will you, sir?"
Reorganize and rewrite the following sentences.
2.
Discard de-
that do not belong.
Getting
lost in the
woods
after the
first
which happens
snowfall,
people than you imagine, especially in the northern woods,
is
to
more
a horrify-
ing experience. 2.
One
such experience which happened to
ing the Thanksgiving
taught 3.
me
Day
vacation while
me I
in
northern Minnesota dur-
was a senior
in high school
a valuable lesson.
had been hunting rabbits with a 22 rifle, and these rabbits, unlike those which are often infected with tularemia, are good to eat, and suddenly everything was changed by a heavy snowfall. I tried to remember what my father, who disliked to go out in the woods himself and absolutely refused to hunt, told me when he talked to our Cub Scout group once; it was to try to remember the last familiar landmark you had seen and retrace your steps to it. I closed my eyes, trying to visualize a familiar scene, just as I had once seen a man do in a TV Western, and when I opened my eyes everything I
in western states,
4.
5.
snapped into place because
I
recognized a familiar tree through the
fall-
ing snow.
SUBORDINATION Subordination of sentence elements
is
ideas or facts into
minor ideas or
main
may be
a device which
used to correct two types of sentence faults
:
(
1 )
clauses within the sentence
facts into a succession of short,
putting minor
and
(
2
)
putting
choppy sentences.
See also section 28c.
The
subordinate elements to which a main clause
may
be
re-
duced are an appositive, a phrase, and a clause. Occasionally something which the writer has expressed in a main clause may be reduced to a single word.
374
29
SUBORDINATION Dependent or minor ideas should be placed
29a,
in
subordinate
constructions in the sentence.
Too much
co-ordination
A
is
a sign of immaturity, in thinking as
"We had a birthday party, and Bobby and Jackie came to the party, and we had ice cream, and we played games." A mature person will not assume that all ideas, details, or facts are of the same importance or that they He knows that some should be expressed on the same level. well as in writing.
thoughts are of
first
child will say,
importance, that
are supporting or
othei-s
explaining details, and he will write sentences that
show
the proper
relationship of one part of the sentence to another.
Immature:
The opening and
iron,
it
to the tunnel
was covered by a
grating,
and
this
was made of
was very heavy.
Better:
The opening to the tunnel was covered by a word in place of the clause.]
a very hca\y iron grating.
[Use
Poor: Grasshoppers, for instance, have a keen sense of hearing, and this
is
centered
in their front knees.
Better:
Grasshoppers have a keen sense of hearing, centered in their front knees. [Use a participial phrase.]
Weak:
The Smithsonian
Institution
is
ing of nature for man's benefit,
constantly working for a better understand-
and
it
gets little or
no
publicity.
Better:
The Smithsonian
Institution
is
constantly working, with
for a better understanding of nature for
man's
benefit.
little
or no publicity,
[Use a prepositional
phrase.]
Weak:
The
great god Jupiter
yards,
and he was the
was honored
for bringing rain to the farms
and
vine-
ruler of the gods.
375
29
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
Better:
The
great Jupiter, the ruler of the gods,
to farms
and vineyards.
was
also
honored
for bringing rain
[Use an appositive.]
Poor:
Rocky Mountain
goats
supplement their
diet.
come
on
to feed
white clay, and they need
this
it
to
Better:
Rocky mountain need
to
goats
come down
supplement their
to feed
on
this
white clay, which they
[Use an adjective clause.]
diet.
Poor:
We
have given away
ship of
many
we have
billions of dollars, but
not gained the friend-
foreign peoples.
Better:
Although we have given away gained the friendship of
many
billions of dollars in foreign aid,
foreign peoples.
we have
not
[Use adverbial clause.]
ineffective. They should The weakness of a long senits length. A long sentence may be highly effective easy flow and rhythm. The weakness lies in its Notice how these sentences by E. Amot Robertson
Long, straggling sentences are often be broken up into compact tence
is
not in
because of
its
shapelessness.
units.
are built on a pattern of parallel clauses, each one adding to the single effect of the whole.
Example: London, sprawling over so many miles, was impossible to miss for the bombers: if they were not picking their targets in detail there was no need for them to come low enough for the few guns or searchlights to matter; and the people knew it. It was disturbing beyond expression, the emanation of close-packed, controlled fear from millions of human beings cowering in shelters, in cellars, keeping their
own homes,
they were workers
up a
fine pretence of indifference in
nervously carrying on with gaiety or trying to sleep,
who must
sleep,
with vaselined cotton wool in their
if
ears,
or their bedclothes over their heads, or their windows closed in the stuffy night; striving to shut out the noise of death
which was
all
they could shut
out.
—E.
Arnot Robertson, The Signpost.
millan Company.
376
Printed by permission of
The Mac-
29
SUBORDINATION
The
cure for the disease of the straggling sentence
nate and divide"
—subordinate
importance, and divide
what seems
is
"subordi-
be of secondary
to
you cannot subordinate.
if
Straggling:
When
was a
I
little girl,
into high-school age I
high school
I
I
did not care for motion pictures, but as
began
to
now
go every week and
do not go so often and
am more
I
that I
am
I
grew
out of
particular about the quality
of the pictures that I see.
Revised:
My
motion pictures has developed through three stages: a comthem in my childhood, a movie-a-week phase in my
in
taste
plete indifference to
high-school
and
days,
my
present discriminating enjoyment of a few of
the best.
Straggling:
my
In
sophomore year the teacher thought that we needed more drill in which was the same course we had had the previous year, my junior year we did not have any English course but instead spent
creative writing,
but in
two terms studying
literature.
Revised:
My
high-school training in English consisted of a two-year course in creative
writing, the second year a repetition of the
first,
and a
year's study of litera-
ture.
Co-ordination and subordination are devices by which a writer
may
give different degrees of emphasis to different parts of his
No one but the writer can know what his intentions were when he wrote a certain sentence. All that we can do is
sentence.
what you really meant to say? Try combining Try subordinating one of them. There will be a difference in the emphasis that you get, but your revised sentence may be closer to what you meant to say." to say,
"Is this
your main clauses.
The
English language has evolved certain sentence patterns that
often go contrary to the norms. this:
living
"It
is
room
For instance,
assumed that what a is
more important
man
to
in a sentence like
on the walls of his him than what he throws into displays
377
29
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
a corner," the important idea
Yet we accept that pattern.
obviously in a subordinate clause. is
good English. There
is
wide ob-
however, to putting the main idea into a "when" clause, as
jection,
in:
is
It
"One day
was pulling weeds
I
timber wolves near the corral."
They Here
You
choice.
There
is
is
I
saw two
usually called
It
say you should have written,
pulling weeds in corral."
garden when
makes many educated people "One day, as I was the garden, I saw two timber wolves near the another instance of the necessity of making a
"upside-down subordination." squirm.
in the
This sort of thing
is
are the one
who
has to
make
it.
a type of excessive subordination, often called "over-
lapping" or "tandem" subordination, that usually results in awk-
ward
sentences.
It is best to
avoid
it.
Poor: I
had heard the warning so often that I was so used to hearing it that I [Three "that" clauses in succession] it was important.
failed to realize that
Better:
Repeated warnings had dulled my appreciation of warnings had been repeated so often that I failed to
One
29b.
should avoid expressing
sentences precisely
in
short,
their importance.
The
realize their importance.
choppy, co-ordinate
a group of ideas that can be expressed more by using subordination.
Again, the reader cannot look into the writer's mind to see what his intentions
were when he wrote a sentence.
In the following
examples, the revisions seem to represent more precisely what the writer
meant
to say.
See also the
comment on
the primer style under section 29a.
Poor:
The performance was to sit down on a chair.
I arose to
over.
Soon
I
go out.
I
was
so nervous that I
had
grew calm again.
Better:
After the performance was over, I arose to go out, but I
had
378
to sit
on a chair until
I
became calmer.
I
was
so nervous that
29
SUBORDINATION Poor:
Back
of the grandstand are the stables.
Each barn
story barns.
accommodate one
is
The
divided into box
stables are long, rambling, onestalls.
Each
stall
is
enough
to
horse.
Better:
The
situated behind the grandstand, are long, rambling, one-story
stables,
barns, each barn divided into stalls large
enough
to
accommodate one horse
apiece.
Exercises Exercise
Use an appositive
1.
to subordinate
one of the clauses
in
each of
the following sentences.
The
1.
girl
looked at the carbon smear on the back of the
typed; she was our
new
first letter
she
had
secretary.
Mr. Ford; he was our
2.
She
3.
4.
The girl's name was Loma, and it was her first job, but she wanted to make a good impression. Her teacher in secretarial science had impressed upon her the importance
5.
Now,
cast a quick, nervous glance at
of three virtues; these to
were neatness, speed, and
her chagrin, she had
made one good
copy, in reverse, on the back of her
Exercise
typed
efficiency.
impression;
it
was a carbon
letter.
Subordinate one of the clauses in each of the following sen-
2.
tences by reducing 1.
first
boss.
to a prepositional or verbal phrase.
it
There are many kinds of birds that winter them is the Alaska robin.
in
our back yard, and
among
3.
They spend the summers in the high altitudes, and then they come here to a warmer climate for the winter. The hummingbird is small and frail, but it travels vast distances.
4.
It
2.
from Central America
flies
supply of food as 5.
The of
grosbeaks
elm
Exercise
it flies
to
Canada, and
it
must have a constant
north.
come here
a
little later,
and they feed on the green seeds
trees.
3.
In each of the following sentences change one of the main
clauses to a subordinate clause. 1.
My
new
boss started out as an office boy,
and he believes
in
hard work.
[Use an adjective clause.] 2.
He
did not have
much formal
position of responsibility.
education, but he advanced rapidly to a
[Use an adverb clause.]
379
30
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
Hard work makes up
3.
for a lack of education; that
his firm belief.
is
[Use a noun clause.] with my head held high, and I almost tripped over shadow on the floor. [Use an adverb clause.] Mr. Ford quickly explained what my work would be; it would consist of taking dictation and typing. [Use a noun clause.] I found my desk, hung up my coat, spoke to another girl in the room, and then the buzzer rang. [Use an adverb clause beginning with after.] I had practiced taking dictation for three years, and so I was not nervous when I re-entered his office. [Use an adverb clause with beI entered his office
4.
a
5.
6.
7.
cause.] I could have been in real trouble, but he was careful to spell out names and technical terms slowly. [Use an adverb clause with if.]
8.
started to type the
I
9.
10.
of
my
I
reversed the
work.
first
letter;
this
should have been the easiest part
[Use an adjective clause with which.] carbon;
first
I
am
still
[Use a noun
wondering why.
clause.!
REFERENCE OF
PRONOUNS
The antecedent of a pronoun
30a,
in
a sentence should be imme-
diately clear to the reader.
As a
rule,
pronouns should have
definite antecedents
special situations.
it
There
rained is
noun you,
number
of idi-
visible antecedent,
such
is
time to go home.
of clearness in these sentences.
Second, the pro-
last
no lack
a
First, there are
omatic phrases in which a pronoun has no as:
in
represented by the phrase "as a rule," refers to
this last sentence,
two or three
and should
The hedging
be placed as near their antecedents as possible.
night;
it's
the climate;
it
in the sense of one, or a person, has
wide currency
in
informal written and spoken English, and occasionally in good
formal writing. to
an idea or
Third, the pronouns which,
fact expressed
a part of a clause,
if
this,
that
may
refer
by a whole clause or a sentence, or by
the reference
is
unmistakably
clear.
In good writing, the meaning of a sentence should be clear to
an
intelligent reader
hesitate,
noun
it
first
reading.
If the
reader has to
he has to search for the substantive to which the pro-
refers, or if
cedents
380
if
on the
he has to puzzle over which of two possible ante-
does refer
to,
the sentence
is
not as good as
it
should be.
REFERENCE OF
And we may add
here that even
muddled sentences
if
you can find a bucketful of
in the writing of great scientists, great educators,
or great public servants, those sentences as
good
30
PRONOUNS
as they could
are
still
muddled and not
have been.
Indefinite: I
can remember that
[To what does
we met many
people, but I did not enjoy
it
very much.
refer?]
it
Clear: I
can remember that we met many people, but
very much.
[Supply the word for which
it
did not enjoy the reception
I
stands.]
Indefinite:
My
mother was a school teacher; therefore it my profession. [The antecedent
chosen that as
no wonder that
is
of that
I
have
only vaguely im-
is
plied.]
Clear:
My
mother was a school teacher; therefore
chosen teaching as
my
it
no wonder that
is
I
have
profession.
Misleading:
Each damaged [The reader
is
article
is
marked
confused because
it
in such a
way
that
it
cannot be erased.
seems to refer to article]
Clear:
Each damaged
article
is
marked
in such a
way
that the
mark cannot be
refer to
an antecedent
erased.
It is usually
awkward
to
in a subordinate position.
have a pronoun
The
reader will instinctively associate a
pronoun with the most prominent substantive just
read.
fusion but
The still
result
is
confusion
—
in the clause
possibly a
he has
momentary con-
an undesirable one.
Confusing:
Men
have lounged and crouched around their fires; they have been the companions of their dreams and meditations. [The reader will hesitate when he comes to "they have," because he will assume that the subject of the sentence
is still
"men."]
381
30
H
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
Clear:
Men
have lounged and crouched around dreams and their meditations.
their fires
Men
have lounged and crouched around their companions of their dreams and meditations.
30b,
—the companions of
fires,
their
since fires have been the
The reference of a pronoun should not be ambiguous.
Ambiguous
He
crossed his other leg, took out a handkerchief from a back pocket, wiped
his forehead,
placed
blew
[Does
it.
his nose,
it
and carefully and methodically folded and
re-
refer to nose?]
Clear:
He
crossed his other leg, took out a handkerchief from a back pocket, wiped
his forehead,
blew
his nose,
handkerchief and replaced
and then carefully and methodically folded the
it.
Ambiguous: Almost
all
of calling
of the merchants
know
their customers
and they are
in the habit
them by name.
Clear:
In a small town everyone knows everyone else so well that even the merchants usually address their customers by name.
Ambiguous At the breakfast social error.
table,
Dorothy told Mary that she had committed a bad Dorothy or Mary?]
[VVho had committed the error?
Clear:
At the breakfast
table,
Dorothy accused Mary of committing
a
bad
social
error.
It is
neither customary nor necessary to resort to an explanatory
antecedent in parentheses after a pronoun. Poor:
Father told the doctor that he (Father) did not think that the war would greatly affect his (the doctor's) profession.
382
30
PRONOUNS
REFERENCE OF Better:
Father said to the doctor, "I do not think that the war
is
going to affect
your profession very much."
30c,
formal and serious writing, the indefinite reference
In
common
We
than
informal writing
are here referring to
you
of the indefinite to
in
mean
people,
to
and
two particular
mean
in
situations:
less
(1) the use
and the indefinite they and which to refer
one^ a person
and (2) the use
is
speech.
of this, that,
to a clause, sentence, or a general idea. 1.
The
indefinite
many forms of The
v/riting.
you and they are
common
informal writing; they are
and
in speech
in
appropriate in formal
less
student should guard against
making
their use a
habit, especially in papers of explanation.
Formal: First
the seed
is
scattered evenly over the ground; then the soil
Hghtly and firmed with a roller.
is
raked
[Note the passive voice here.]
Colloquial: First
you scatter the seed; then you rake
it
and firm the
in
soil
with a
roller.
Formal:
When
a soldier salutes, he must stand
up smartly
up
straight
and bring
his right
hand
to the visor of his cap.
Colloquial:
\Vhen
saluting,
you must stand up straight and bring your
right
hand up
smartly to the visor of your cap. Form.al: Fraternities are not permitted in
some
colleges in the East.
Colloquial:
They
(or
You) do not have
fraternities in
some
colleges in the East.
Form.al:
In the a^rmy, a soldier does not ask; he obeys.
383
30
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
Colloquial:
In the army, you do not ask; you do what you are told.
A
pronoun may have a clause or a sentence for its antemay even refer to a thought expressed by a part of the preceding sentence. As long as the reference is unmistakable, the 2.
cedent;
sentence
it
is
But the
clear.
careless writer
may
stringing together a series of "this," "that,"
without
troubling
Whenever the
himself
fall into
the habit of
and "which"
clauses
about either clearness or exactness.
writer suspects the clearness or definiteness of
an
antecedent, he should try to summarize the general idea of the clause referred to
by using some expression
a fact which, and so forth.
tion,
like this fact, this condi-
If the result is
still
unsatisfactory,
he should rewrite the sentence. Notice that the references are entirely clear in the following sentences. Clear:
have given up smoking. That should please my mother. So you have decided to support my candidate. This is indeed a Father suggested that I keep the money, which I did without a I
Now notice the vague references in
surprise. protest.
the following.
Vague: After locking the beasts in the bam, is
one of the
sleep," but
which could
I
hunting cows.
effects of
refer to
went to bed and slept soundly, which [The writer evidently means "sound
two other things
in the sentence.]
Clear:
After locking the beasts in the barn,
sound sleep
is
one of the
effects of
I
went
to
bed and
slept soundly, for
hunting cows.
Vague: If a girl suspects that
her roommate needs help or a friendly word of en-
couragement, she should do
it
before
it is
too late.
[Do what?]
Clear: If
a
girl suspects that
her roommate needs help or a friendly word of en-
couragement, she should offer assistance before
384
it is
too late.
PRONOUNS
REFERENCE OF
30
Vague:
The
fish are kept alive and fresh in glass tanks, and it also attracts people, which helps the business considerably. [What do it and which refer to?]
Clear:
The
fish
are kept alive
and
fresh in glass tanks.
The
display of live fish
helps business by attracting people to the place.
30d,
The careless use of same, such, above, and said as refer-
ence words often produces an
These words are used
awkward
as reference
words
sentence.
in legal or technical
writing; in ordinary writing they should be avoided, not because
they are incorrect but because they usually lead to awkwardness of expression.
or the
name
Use one
common pronouns
them,
this)
monkey wrench and oil can in my hands. same to the engine room.
The
of the
of the thing to
which you
(it,
refer.
Poor: I
stood there holding the
foreman ordered
me
to return the
Better: I
stood there holding the
foreman ordered
me
monkey wrench and
oil
to return the tools to the engine
can in
my
hands.
The
room.
Poor:
The
significance of said decision
is
not yet fully comprehended.
Better:
The
significance of the decision referred to
is
not yet fully comprehended.
Poor: Please return same to
me
by bearer.
Better:
Please return
it
[or
name
the object] to
me
by the bearer of
this note.
Poor:
The above
is
a complete refutation of their arguments.
Better:
These
facts
completely refute their arguments.
385
30 30e.
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
A
pronoun should agree with
its
antecedent
in
number,
gender, and person.
For a discussion of the agreement of pronouns and antecedents "Pronouns," section 4j. Note also that the "everybody-their"
see
construction
common
is
in conversational usage.
Poor: advise every beginner to purchase the best instruments they can afford.
I
[Every
is
singular
and therefore must be followed by a singular pronoun.]
Better:
advise every beginner to purchase the best instruments he can afford.
I
Poor:
When of
an orchestra becomes
upon
successful, their success reflects
leadership they have had.
[You must be
consistent.
If
the type
you begin by
considering orchestra as singular, you must continue to refer to
it
as
one
unit.]
Better:
When
an orchestra becomes
ship
has had,
it
30f.
It is
the
usually
successful,
awkward
its
success reflects the kind of leader-
to begin an essay with
a reference
to
title.
If the title
is
the
same
as the subject of the
better to repeat the w^ords of the
title.
first
For instance,
sentence, if
your
it
is
title is
"Trout Fishing," do not begin your paper, "This has always been
my
favorite sport."
Say, "Trout fishing has always been
my
favor-
ite sport."
Exercise 1. In each of the following sentences underline the pronoun or pronouns with faulty reference. Rewrite each sentence so as to correct the
Exercise
error. 1.
The
2.
Dynamite
dean's duties are that of a mother. is
placed on the rock, and after breaking the rock
into cars to be taken away.
386
it is
loaded
31
PROPER ARRANGEMENT Although one would think that he
3.
lives
on excitement, they would be
mistaken. 4.
The
5.
We
here
soil
sandy and loose, which makes
is
it
easy digging.
Many
often see peculiar resemblances between people and animals.
times
it
is
not meant to be uncomplimentary, and this
one of those
is
instances,
When
6.
a person
first
meets her, they notice that she has a scar over her
right eye.
We
7.
many
built
bridges over small
swamps which kept
us constantly oc-
cupied.
He seldom reprimands
8.
us for anything, but
when he
does,
is
it
always
taken seriously. If I
9.
meet a person and they
sit
and constantly complain,
it
doesn't
make
a good impression on me. 10.
would prefer
I
getting a job at the
Medical School
this year,
doing odd
jobs for them.
PROPER ARRANGEMENT The parts of a sentence should be so arranged that the meaning
37.
of the sentence Since English
is
is
clear at the
in
it.
reading.
not a highly inflected language, the meaning of
an English sentence depends words
first
The
largely
on the arrangement of the
reader naturally assumes that the parts of a
sentence which are placed next to each other are logically related to
each other.
You must therefore be careful to arrange words such a way that its meaning will be clear on the The rule which will guide you may be stated in two
in a sentence in first
reading.
parts
:
( 1 )
place
all
modifiers,
as close as possible to the
these elements near other
7.
THE PROBLEM
whether words, phrases, or
clauses,
words they modify; (2) avoid placing
words they might be taken
to modify.
OF ONLY AND NOT.
These two adverbs are here singled out for comment because they have been problem children for a long time.
adverb should be placed near the word
it
Logically,
an
modifies; idiomatically,
For instance, would you say, "We have room for only two more," or, "We only have room for two it
is
often placed elsewhere.
387
31
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
more"?
The person with a logical mind says that "only" modifies the person who prefers the second form answers that idiom
"two^';
much
does not pay
by calling
of "only"
and
of the sentence,
He
attention to logic.
explains the position
a "sentence adverb," modifying the thought
it
therefore
its
proper position
The second
Both forms are used.
is
is
before the verb.
used generally in speech,
and often in formal writing. and speakers who are disturbed
in a great deal of informal writing,
The
form
first
is
used by writers
No
by the sound of the other form.
statistical
study of the inci-
dence of each form in formal writing has been made.
The same
Would you
explanation applies to "not."
everyone can be tions the first
first,"
say:
"Not
or "Everyone can't be first"? Logic sanc-
form; idiom sanctions the second form
—
at least in
speech and informal writing.
Only
slightly less controversial
is
the placing of several other
adverbs, such as almost, nearly, merely, scarcely.
Common He He
in
speech:
merely said only took
it
fifth
because he did not stop to think. place in the race.
Every student cannof win honors in
The
college.
canteen only contained about two cups of water.
Harry almost weeded the whole garden
More
He He
logical
said
it
merely because he did not stop to think. fifth
place in the race.
Not every student can win honors
in college.
canteen contained only about two cups of water.
Harry weeded almost the whole garden
2.
morning.
and preferred by many:
took only
The
this
this
morning.
PHRASES,
Misplaced:
He began
to lose his desire to reach the
to to reach or I
began
was dressed and ready
to start climbing within
being dressed or to starting to
Every
388
girl
was
summit
after a time.
[Does
it
refer
to lose?]
really sorry to
an hour.
[Does
it
refer to
climb.'']
have the
trip
end for more reasons than one.
31
PROPER ARRANGEMENT Clear:
He began
after a time to lose his desire to reach the
Within an hour
I
was dressed and ready
For more reasons than one, every
girl
summit.
to start climbing.
was
have the
really sorry to
trip end.
[Refers to being sorry, not to the trip ending.^
3.
CLAUSES,
Misplaced:
When you were
a child do you
remember
all
the interesting toys you had?
[Does the clause refer to remember or to toys you had?] Clear:
Do
you remember
i.
SQUINTING MODIFIERS.
all
the interesting toys you
had when you were a child?
Modifiers so placed in a sentence that they
may
be understood
with either the preceding or the following words are called squinting modifiers.
means
As a
rule,
it is
better not to try to cure the fault
by
of punctuation.
Squinting:
Because ing the
we covered more ground with
a tractor in six days
we
finished plow-
field.
Clear:
Because we covered more ground with a
tractor,
we
finished plowing the
field in six days.
Squinting:
we had stopped at a service station with the help we found our position on the map. [Putting a comma After
of a lady attendant after station
is
not
a satisfactory correction.]
CI ear: After
we had stopped
locate our position
at a service station,
a lady attendant helped us to
on the map.
389
31
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
Squinting:
As we drove westward every now and then the blinding shone into our eyes. rection.
[Putting a
comma
after
westward
is
rays of the sun
a makeshift cor-
does not eliminate the confusion entirely.]
It
Clear:
As we drove westward,
the blinding rays of the sun frequently shone into our
eyes.
THE SPLIT INFINITIVE.
5.
Placing an adverbial modifier between the sign to and the verb of
an
infinitive results in
infinitive."
The
what
known
traditionally
is
split infinitive is
seven deadly sins of college composition
—
ever was.
if it
true that the parts of an infinitive are inseparable. infinitive
split
suffering,
it is
still
causes
many
as the "split
no longer considered one of the It
is
not
But since a
persons discomfort,
if
not actual
better for the student not to split his infinitives too
rashly or promiscuously.
A
good
when such an arrangement
rule to follow
and the verb
adverbial modifier between to is
of
this:
is
an
place the
infinitive only
necessary to avoid an
awkward
phrase. Split infinitive:
A
writer should
remember
to not carelessly split his infinitives.
Better:
A
6.
writer should
remember not
to split his infinitives carelessly.
ANY WORDS THAT NORMALLY BELONG NEAR EACH OTHER SHOULD NOT BE SEPARATED.
IN GENERAL,
This statement applies particularly to subject and verb, verb and object, the parts of a verb phrase, substantives fiers,
and substantives and
and
adjective modi-
appositives.
Awkward:
The
explorers had, after
many
adventures and
headwaters of the Salmon River. phrase]
390
much
suffering,
reached the
[Verb had reached separated by long
PROPER ARRANGEMENT
31
Improved:
many
After
much
adventures and
had reached the
suffering, the explorers
headwaters of the Salmon River.
Awkward: Before
became
it
dark, the stragglers caught
discouraged.
wet,
[Adjective
up with the main party, from the word
separated
modifiers
tired,
they
modify]
Improved: Before
became
it
dark, the tired, wet,
and discouraged
stragglers caught
up
with the main party.
Awkward: Holmes,
Justice
Amendment,
in
a
brilliantly
written
interpretation
of
the
Fourteenth
[Subject and verb split by a long phrase]
dissented.
Better: Justice
teenth
Holmes dissented Amendment.
in a brilliantly written interpretation of the Four-
Exercise Exercise
misplaced element in each of the following
Point out the
1,
sentences.
Correct each sentence.
Do
not use punctuation as a means of
correcting an error. 1.
Twenty
years ago girls used to
come
where
to school
I
was principal
without any stockings on. 2.
I shall
attempt to explain the function of the least known, to one
who
does not play the game, section of the football team. 3.
Their activity and progress in recent years have surprised the world.
4.
At one time
5.
Masefield has
6.
We
were
I
He
many
that she
had three engagement
when
rings.
ideas about things that are difTerent.
finally settled in seats that cost twice as
for our tickets 7.
remember
much
as
we had paid
the play began.
usually has a lapful of food at the close of the dinner which he
brushes to the floor to be stepped on by some other boarder. 8.
9.
If you should disturb her by coming in late, you will hear that she was awakened for the next three months. There is a telephone at the end of the counter which is constantly in
use.
391
32
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
Freshman English courses are taught by
10.
to
have
at least a master's degree in
11.
He would
12.
A
tell
me
crowd gathers
to look
most
up words
to sorrowfully gaze
instructors
who
are required
colleges.
could not spell in the dictionary.
I
upon the destruction
of the
mag-
nificent structure.
He
13.
finally
had
to
prove that his rival was a coward in order to hold
his wife.
The
14.
pleasant, merry-faced girl seems exactly like a
violet with
its
up-
turned face to the sun.
16.
The woman was arrested Wood can be kept for
17.
woodshed or the basement. A year later I went to several
15.
for shoplifting by a private detective.
a long time without danger of rotting in the
classes
with
five
or six other children
conducted by our minister. 18.
The freshmen
19.
Why
20.
only have to wear their green caps one year. do they spend all their money, time, and effort to please a man with a new dress and a fingerwave? The new laboratory at Dairen has found new uses too numerous to mention for the soy bean.
DANGLING MODIFIERS 32a,
Awkward
dangling modifiers should be avoided.
At present there
is
"dangling modifier."
Some
say that
results in it
wrong word.
calls attention to itself it is
bad.
it
should be called the "mis-
When
it
it
actually attaches
does, especially is
it
When
bad.
and away from the intended meaning of that it can be bad because
many educated persons have been slovenly way of writing. Here are some examples While reading
it
itself
when
One might add
so
When
as the
traditionally
confusion or in unintentional humor,
the sentence,
known
is
related modifier," for instead of dangling
too easily to the
among
considerable diflference of opinion
educated people over the use of what
taught to regard
it
as a
of danglers
my
delicately
morning paper, the toast burned. browned on both sides and sizzling
hot, she called to the
guests to bring their plates.
Driving along the park highway, an old brown bear could be seen squarely in the middle of the road.
392
sitting
:
32
DANGLING MODIFIERS In each of these sentences, dangles because related because
tence
A
is
it
it
it
does not matter whether the phrase
not attached where
is
attaches
itself
where
it
it
should be or
should not be.
mis-
is
Each
sen-
bad.
dangler
may
be corrected in two ways
:
(
1 )
by changing the
phrase to a clause and (2) by providing a noun or pronoun to
which the dangler can properly attach
itself.
Examples:
While I was reading my morning paper, the toast burned. While reading my morning paper, I burned my toast. When the steak was delicately browned on both sides and
sizzling hot, the
hostess asked the guests to bring their plates.
Driving along the park highway, in the
we
Before
old
brown bear
sitting squarely
the various types of "dangling" or "misrelated"
list
two or three
modifiers, let us look at
The word
1.
the
we saw an
middle of the road.
special situations.
In the absolute phrase
absolute phrase does not dangle. that the participle attaches
itself
to
is
in the phrase
itself.
Examples:
The The
day's
work being
over,
guests having arrived.
Three more
returned to town. to the door.
wet hair plastered down over
their
girls,
we
Mother went
their eyes,
stumbled
into the classroom.
2.
Certain idiomatic phrases, especially those that express a gen-
eral action
and those
that serve as directive
always acceptable in
are
These are phrases
either
like generally
and
transitional links,
formal or informal situations.
speaking, looking at
it
from another
point of view, taking everything into consideration, providing that .
.
.
,
failing
.
.
.
,
and
others that are similar.
Examples: Failing agreement, the meeting
was adjourned.
Generally speaking, the worse a pun
The
is,
the better
it is.
following are types of objectionable verbal phrases
393
32
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
OR GERUND.
THE PARTICIPLE
7.
Dangling:
Having a Chinese name, Chinese customs.
my
me
asked
teacher
write a
to
paper about
[The reader associates having with teacher.
Actually the
participle refers to the person represented by me.]
Upon
asking
him
to explain,
he told
me
was born and brought up
that he
in Seattle.
Revised: Since
have a Chinese name,
I
my
teacher asked
me
paper about
to write a
Chinese customs.
When
me
asked him to explain, he told
I
was born and brought up
that he
in Seattle.
THE DANGLING INFINITIVE.
2.
Awkward:
To
succeed as a coach, the style of play must be adapted to
fit
the available
material.
To To
appreciate this poem,
it
must be read aloud.
enjoy outdoor sports, sensible clothing must be worn.
Revised:
one
If
is
to succeed as a coach,
the material at his
To
appreciate this poem, one must read
poem can be
This
A
he must be able to adapt his
better appreciated
if
THE DANGLING PHRASE
OF
aloud.
it
you read
person can enjoy outdoor sports better
3.
style of play to
command.
if
it
aloud.
he wears sensible clothing.
RESULT.
Awkward: I
my
helped
my
English
I sold
my
money
to
mother wash clothes
class.
[Who caused me
this
morning, thus causing
to miss
my
me
to
miss
class?]
automobile for three hundred dollars, thereby giving
pay
my
my
English class this morning because
me enough
debts.
Revised: I
missed
my
help
The pay
sale all
394
mother wash of
my
my
debts.
I
had
home
to
enough
to
to stay at
clothes.
automobile brought
me
three
hundred
dollars,
32
DANGLING MODIFIERS Misrelated
32b,
elliptical clauses
may
produce an unintentionally
ludicrous meaning.
In an
is
associates the clause with the
In
implied or understood.
elliptical clause the subject is
such a construction there
sometimes a danger that the reader
wrong word
in the rest of the sentence.
Awkward: His foot was injured while swimming in Wild Cat Hole.
[Was the
foot
swimming?]
When
six years of age,
[Who was
my
father took the family to a farm near Calgary.
six years of age?]
While on a tour
Mexico,
of
my
expensive camera was stolen.
Revised:
His foot was injured while he was swimming in Wild Cat Hole.
When I was six years old, my father took the family to a farm near Calgary. While we were on a tour of Mexico, my expensive camera was stolen.
A
32c,
sentence with any sort of expression,
oppos/f/Ve, that
sentence
is
awkward and
is
like
a phrase or an
not easily understood with the rest of the usually misleading.
Illogical:
A
gentleman farmer,
his
four-buckle rubber boots. in apposition
wardrobe ranges from faultlessly tailored suits to [The expression a gentleman farmer seems to be
with wardrobe.]
After five years in a city school, a country school presents in
adjustment.
many problems
[One naturally associates the opening phrase with a country
school.]
Revised:
As he suits to
A
is
a gentleman farmer, his wardrobe ranges from faultlessly tailored
four-buckle rubber boots.
person
who
has spent
five years in a city
school encounters
many
prob-
lems in adjustment when he goes to a country school.
The dangling
or misrelated modifier,
examples offered,
is
a
stylistic
even momentary confusion, or
blunder. if it is
it
can be seen from the If
it
causes confusion,
associated with an unasked-
395
32
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
for ludicrous image,
many
used by
For a discussion of danglers
undesirable.
it is
professional writers, see Pooley's Teaching English
Usage, pp. 107-113.
Exercises Exercise
Which
1.
of
following
the
objectionable
contain
sentences
Correct any error that you find.
danglers? 1.
Moving
2.
After moving to Arizona, her health improved.
3.
6.
had started to rain. it from spreading. The fire having been extinguished, everyone went to sleep again. Meeting him by chance on the street, he told me he had decided to quit
7.
Being
8.
After asking
9.
Entering the North Gate, the
4. 5.
to a drier climate, her
After eating our dinners,
We
threw sand upon the
we
asthma improved quickly.
noticed that
it
thus preventing
fire,
school.
10.
late,
my entrance made a deep impression upon the class. my name, the professor repeated the next day's assignment.
Being too small for
worth Exercise
its
up
in,
I
stands out prominently.
thought the
new
car was not
Some
contain
Pick out the faulty sentences and correct them.
my camera
accompanies
me on
trip.
The camera being rest of the
3.
new chapel
Being an enthusiastic photographer, every
2.
sit
of the following sentences are correct.
objectionable danglers. 1.
to
price.
Some
2.
me
a delicate instrument,
it
is
never packed with the
equipment.
After putting
it
on the car
seat beside
me,
I
usually cover
it
with a
sweater. 4.
Being thus exposed
to the hot sun,
you may discover that your film has
been ruined. 5. 6.
To get When
an
the conditions must be right.
artistic picture, all
taking
pictures
with
color
film,
autumn
foliage
is
a
favorite
subject. 7.
After driving almost to the rim of Crater Lake crater, the clouds drifted
8.
Being
away and the sun shone at a
brilliantly.
high altitude, a polarizing
filter is
attached to the lens, thus
increasing the contrast between the blues and the whites. 9.
To
use a polarizer successfully, the sun must be at your right or your
left as
10.
you take the picture.
After using the polarizer, filter,
396
thereby doubling
my
I
took some more pictures with a skylight
chances of getting some unusual pictures.
:
EMPHASIS IN THE SENTENCE
33
EMPHASIS IN THE SENTENCE The relafive importance of ideas
33,
by
various devices of structure.
a sentence may be shown is known
in
The principle used
as "emphasis/'
"Emphasis"
A
sense.
is
may
a word that
be understood in more than one
may emphasize some of his words by shouting may emphasize words by indicating italics Some writers and speakprinted in or capitals.
speaker
or screaming
that they be
them; a writer
ers
have used these methods.
we
use the
But that
not the sense in which
is
word here. By "emphasis" we mean using rhetorical that show the relative importance or prominence of ideas
devices
in a sentence or a
paragraph.
Some
we have
of these devices
al-
ready discussed in connection with other quahties of good writing
—
clarity,
Two
directness,
coherence,
order,
conciseness,
directness.
or three others will be pointed out here and in the following
sections. It
may be
relative
1.
2. 3. 4.
5. 6. 7.
8.
9.
10.
By By By By By By By By By By
well to restate here the various devices by which the
importance of ideas can be shown
placing an important idea by
main
placing the idea in the
itself in
a short sentence.
clause of a
changing the usual order of a sentence. using parallel structure.
complex sentence. (Sympathy I did not want!)
(See section 35.)
using the order of climax.
repeating key words.
(See section 26a.)
using the active instead of the passive voice. giving an important idea a fuller treatment.
placing important words in prominent positions. using periodic structure.
THE EMPHATIC POSITION 33a,
The relative importance of ideas can be indicated by placing the important
words
The most conspicuous and the end.
in
the important positions
in
the sentence.
positions in the sentence are the beginning
These are the positions that should be used for ideas
that deserve attention
and emphasis.
The
less
important
details,
397
33
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
the modifiers, the transitional phrases should be placed within the sentenc^e.
No
writer can consistently rearrange his sentences so as to begin
and end them with important ideas. Many sentences are so short the reader's mind comprehends them as units. In many others the word order is determined by the nature of the English language. For example, we write: "He is a good man." "Her son was killed in France." "The day's work is done." "The that
President saluted the flag."
emphatic position cannot
Whenever
In sentences Hke these the question of
arise.
possible without sacrificing clearness
and smoothness,
place explanatory phrases or minor details within the sentence.
Weak: However, the general disclaimed any
The
who
student
responsibility for the order.
cheats in an examination
is
cheating only himself in the
final analysis.
Public speaking should be taught in freshman English,
I think.
Better:
The
general, however, disclaimed any responsibility for the order.
The
student
who
cheats in an examination
is,
think, should be taught in
freshman English.
in the final analysis, cheating
only himself. Public speaking,
I
THE PERIODIC FORM 33b,
Occasionally one
may
express a thought more effectively
by
changing a sentence from the loose to the periodic form.
A
not complete until the end
is
effect of the periodic sentence
is
sentence in which the thought
called a periodic sentence.
The
is
Your reader, in other words, is forced to wait for main idea until after he has comprehended the subordinate Not all sentences in details upon which the main idea is based. one of suspense.
the
English are periodic; a large majority of them, in fact, are loose. It is precisely is
emphatic.
398
because of
this that
an occasional periodic sentence
—
33
EMPHASIS IN THE SENTENCE Study the difference
in effect
produced by the following:
Loose:
Stop talking
if
you have nothing more
of course impractical to legislate for those
It is
while completely ignoring those
The
to say.
who
who
will
behave themselves
will not.
catalytic agents of college life are athletics, forensics, musical organiza-
tions,
journalism, parties, and dances.
Periodic: If
you have nothing more to
To
who
legislate for those
those
who
will not
is,
say, stop talking.
will
behave themselves while completely ignoring
of course, impractical.
Athletics, forensics, musical organizations, journalism, parties, dances
are the catalytic agents of college
—these
life.
Here are two examples of long periodic sentences. Notice in how suspense is built up by delaying the main statement until
each
the end.
In the almost unique intimacy and good-fellowship of Oxford for the
moment men from
life,
where
every nation and every class are living together
and surveying the nations of the earth in human and humorous companionship, the Rhodes Scholar, if he has in him the capacity for wisdom, learns the difference between an abstract formula and a living point of view. Frank Aydelotte, "What the American Rhodes Scholar Gets from Oxford."
—
To
from the thing possessed to its possessor; to conmere possession of material wealth makes of its possessor a
transfer admiration
ceive that the
proper object of worship; to feel abject before another such emotions do not so
much
as enter the
who
American mind.
is
wealthier
—Hilaire
Belloc.
Exercises Exercise
1.
Using the principle of "emphasis by position," improve the
following sentences.
2.
Duty is what we expect from others, American youth is more interested
3.
Generally speaking,
1.
as
someone has
said.
in security than in adventure, accord-
ing to the writer's opinion.
modem
youth has had
all
the adventure
it
can stand.
399
33 4.
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
The
great adventures of the future will be in outer space, according to
the convocation speaker. 5.
The
challenging
new
mind and
frontiers are those of the
the soul, the
speaker pointed out. Exercise 1.
Why
2.
Change
the following loose sentences to periodic sentences.
are not mountain tops
warmer than
their bases since they are closer
to the sun? 2.
The
sun's heat rays pass right through the air at the top of a
because the air at such altitudes 3.
4.
5.
is
mountain
very thin.
Modern, American-style motels are being built in some of the Western European countries. Many American tourists will enjoy their conveniences after they had spent the day walking and driving. Let the others have their quaint hotels if they value atmosphere more than comfort.
OR
ACTIVE
PASSIVE VOICE
The passive voice should be avoided where the active
33c.
more natural and
The fault;
use of the passive voice it
is
the overuse of
properly used
when
( 1 )
is
direct.
it
is
that
not a grammatical or a is
a
The
fault.
stylistic
passive voice
is
the object or receiver of the action of the
more important than the doer, (2) the doer of the action is not known, (3) the writer wishes to place the emphasis on the receiver instead of on the doer. verb
is
Examples: Several priceless old manuscripts were destroyed.
The wounded
prisoner was dragged into the trench.
But notice the difTerence
in the following sentences
when
the
active voice replaces the passive.
Weak: Other games are
also played by the guests.
As the top of the stairs is approached, a quickening is announced by the trembling of the floor.
The Supday immensely by
400
dinner all.
is
a meal at which everyone
of the steps of the person
is
present and
is
enjoyed
34
EMPHASIS IN THE SENTENCE
agonizing minutes are spent by the student in deciding on a subject
Many
for a speech.
Better:
The
guests also play other games. of the stairs, the trembling of the floor
As the intruder approaches the top announces the quickening of his
Sunday dinner
steps.
a meal at which everyone
is
is
present and which everyone
enjoys.
The
student spends
many
agonizing minutes deciding upon a subject for a
speech.
Exercise Exercise
Improve the following sentences by changing the verbs from
1.
the passive to the active. 1.
But
2.
A
his suggestion
was received by me with disdain. which momentarily illuminates the boy's
last pufT is taken,
a glowing arc
is
noticed
when
the cigarette
is
face,
and
flicked across the lawn.
was to be just a "kid dance," but it was soon was great fun. With his help the mistake was soon corrected by us. Here and there are heard whispered explanations and giggles. My courses were not given much thought by me. Three women came in, and the question "Are you relatives of the groom?" was asked. A daily trip is made to the attic to wipe the dust from her keepsakes, and then she sheds a tear or two over them. The tractor cannot be driven and the mowing machine manipulated by one man at the same time. I
3.
had heard
that the party
found out that
4. 5. 6. 7.
8.
9.
it
In the laboratory
10.
all
this extensive study,
in detail. out,
If
is
studied by chemists.
The data
no satisfactory
results are obtained,
trials
are carried
SHIFT IN POINT
Any
on
first
trial
After
are recorded
another study
but this time the data obtained from the
These
34,
available information
experiments are performed.
is
carried
are included.
until satisfactory results are gained.
OF VIEW
unnecessary and
illogical shift in point
of
vie}/>^
should be
avoided.
The most common passive voice,
(
2
)
shifts in
from past
point of view are
to present tense,
(
3
( 1 )
)
from active
from one
to
to you,
401
34
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
(4) from indirect to direct discourse, (5) from formal to colloquial
Writing
style.
is
more pleasing
of view unless, of course, he has
if
the writer maintains his point
some
logical reason for
changing
to another.
Unnecessary
34a,
shifts
from active to passive voice are undesir-
able. Shift:
Every boy
up
rolls
his sleeping
doused with water and earth
We
is
bag and carries
it
to the truck; fires are
spread over them.
swept the room carefully, and the furniture and shelves were also
dusted. Better:
Every boy
rolls his sleeping bag, carries
it
to the truck, douses the fires
with
water, and spreads earth over them.
VVe carefully swept the room and dusted the furniture and the shelves.
Needless
34b,
to
shifts in
past—are
tense
—from past
to present or from present
usually objectionable.
Shift:
mother but receives an evasive reply. (This must be watched for in narrative accounts.] I begin to get a little curious and stuck my head from under the blanket [The to see who should be prowling around at that time of the night. writer shifts from present to past to future.] Elsie asked the doctor about her sort of shift,
,
from past
to present,
Better: Elsie asked the doctor about her
mother but received an evasive
[Both
reply.
verbs in the past tense] I
began to get a
blanket to see
little
curious and stuck
who was prowling around
my head
out from under the
at that time of the night.
[All
three verbs in past tense]
A
34c,
needless
shift in
number and person should be avoided.
Shift:
You must make
yourself interesting to the group that listens to you
constantly trying to detect your mistakes. once,
402
it
[If
group
is
and are
used as a singular
should not be used as a plural in the same sentence.]
SHIFT IN POINT
34
OF VIEW
Better {informal style):
You must make
yourself interesting to the group that listens to you
and
is
constantly trying to detect your mistakes.
Correct in a formal context:
One must always make and
himself interesting to the group that listens to
him
constantly trying to detect his mistakes.
is
Shift:
mouth
is
dry, eat a
mouth
is
dry,
If one's
lump
of sugar or
chew gum.
[Shift
from one
to you.]
Better: If one's
doubtful, however,
if
one should eat a lump of sugar or chew gum. [It is any person who used one with such formal precision
would chew gum.]
An
34d,
unnecessary
shift
in
subject or perspective
usually
is
awkward. Shift:
Miller was a great athlete, but studying was not his strong point. I
am
taking a course in forestry, though
life
in the
woods does not
greatly
appeal to me. Better:
Miller was a great athlete but a poor student. I
am
taking a course in forestry, although I
am
not especially fond of a
life
in the woods.
34e,
A
needless
shift
from indirect to direct discourse
is
awkward.
Illogical:
The
He
girls
my
wonder, "Is
asked us would
we
find
hair
him
combed?
Will
this
dress suit
my
figure?"
a room.
Consistent:
The
He
girls
wonder, "Is
my
hair
asked us to find him a room.
combed?
He
asked
Will us,
this dress suit
"Will you find
my figure?" me a room?"
403
34
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
A shift from the formal to the colloquial style in serious writing
34f,
is
usually inappropriate.
Inappropriate:
The main
fault of the League of Nations was that the big shots would not gang up on any large nation that was breaking the peace.
The Russian upon
their
Formal
authorities
merchant ships
seemed in the
to
be steamed up about another attack
Mediterranean.
style:
The main
fault of the League of Nations was that the great powers refused combine against any one of their group that was breaking the peace. The Russian authorities seemed to be angered by another attack upon their merchant ships in the Mediterranean. to
A
34g,
constructions in
A
two
writer should guard against mixing
a
The
separate
sentence.
"mixed construction"
writing.
distinctly
is
and careless and immediately, look back on what he has written,
usually the result of hasty
writer begins one construction,
without troubling himself to
continues with another construction. Mixed: In our basement front,
made
not remove
it
its
we found
a small
resemble a fireplace.
own
front,
wood
stove,
[Which
nor can the stove
which upon removing the
refers to stove.
make
itself
The
stove can-
resemble anything.]
Clear:
In our basement
we found
place by removing
In our basement
made
it
its
a small
wood
stove,
which we made
a small
wood
stove.
By removing
into a fire-
front.
we found
its
front,
we
resemble a fireplace.
Mixed: She did not say a word, but took me to the back yard in what seemed to a bit hurriedly. [The writer has forgotten his original intention. He could say either took me in what seemed a hurried manner or took me a
me bit
hurriedly^
Occasionally a writer will run an independent clause into a sentence in such a
404
way
that
it
appears to stand as the subject of a verb.
SHIFT IN POINT
OF VIEW
34
Mixed: had no money was the reason I did not buy it. was disliked by her stepmother was the reason why she
I
Elsie
left
London.
Clear: I
It because I had no money. London because she was disliked by her stepmother.
did not buy
Elsie left
A
34h,
writer should be on his guard against unintentional
or absurdity
humor
serious writing.
in
Poor: In
my
case I apply golf to myself as others apply stamps or antiques to
themselves.
saw a spout of water and I thought it was a whale, but I don't know what kind of fish it was. To build a good model takes time and patience to have a good model when I
you are
finished.
34i,
Mixed
figures of speech are inappropriate in serious writing.
In the teaching of writing, warnings against scrambled meta-
phors
may have been
A
prominence. It is surely
a
mixed metaphor
lesser hterary
uninspired prose.
probably need phors
are
given an undeserved and an unfortunate
If
little
is
often a sign of mental vitality.
crime than page after page of dull and
you scramble two incongruous images, you
more than a
inappropriate.
It
is
hint to
show you
"watering the spark of originality," or "blazing a of
knowledge," or of "being blinded by a
Even Shakespeare spoke If
of taking
that your meta-
absurd to speak of
manifestly
trail
for revenge."
up arms against a
sea of troubles.
your instructor points out a mixed figure of speech
ing,
laugh over
He
it.
will
it
with drops of kindness and
the springs of originality their light over
The
many
following
may
your writ-
mixed metaphor foreshadows, fertilize it
blossom forth
illustrate
what
is
with praise, so that
like
arid pages of prose writing
samples
in
laugh with you and then "encourage
the spark of imagination whiich the
water
over the sea
thirst
a tree
and shed
!"
meant by "mixed
imagery."
405
34
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
Many
high-school athletes think they can ride on their high-school laurels
on was
right into a position
tlie
The
at
future of jazz
[How can one ride on a laurel?] [Even were the future not trans-
college team.
lowest ebb.
its
ported to the past, a rare feat in
how
itself,
could a future ebb?]
Instead of narrowly pursuing the mechanics of grammar, the clever teacher
which will make the class fairly rock with [Can "mechanics" be pursued, either narrowly or broadly?]
will often digress into anecdotes
laughter.
A
college education enables the graduate to
meet the snares and
pitfalls
of life with a broader point of view.
Exercises Exercise
The
1.
following
are
from
sections
student
papers.
Rewrite
each in the past tense.
The door
1.
closed with
customary protest, and we stand in the dark-
its
ness.
"Hey, quit jiggling
my
bed.
Can't you see I'm trying to sleep?" com-
plained a plaintive voice.
Then
hands
at last with groping
blankets, but the
me
the covers pulled snugly around
admitted another freshman,
A
2.
tall,
well-groomed
He
room.
I find
who
man
I
I ease myself into the
bed.
its
prepare to sleep.
in passing, gives
greets the students with a
warm
With
nightly protestation.
my
Then
bed another
wearing a black pin-striped
a friend as well as an instructor.
is
my
bed groaned and squeaked
smile that
suit
the door jiggling.
entered the
made them
feel
His deep voice reassured them.
he
His
brown sparkling eyes were cheerful and mischievous, and his jet black mustache gave him the air of a comic-opera villain. There isn't a bit of curl in his straight black hair. It is neat and always has the look of just having been combed and brushed. Exercise
In each of the following sentences specify the type of illogical
2.
you find
shift that
—
in tense, voice, subject,
number, or person.
Then make
the necessary corrections. 1.
The
train
was two hours
late, so
Mrs. Smith and
I
decide to wait in the
car. 2.
3.
Never before had I operated an elevator, but it surely must be simple because all you had to do was to press a button, which I did. There was just one short half hour of work left. The clerks in the sports department, where I am working, are busy bustling around trying to get rid of the last shoppers.
4.
In some
cases,
when
the person was released from prison he committed
another crime, and from then on usually leads a 5.
Many
girls
becoming a
406
life
of crime.
who live in the poor sections of the town would member of a Camp Fire Girls group.
profit
by
35
PARALLEL STRUCTURE
We
6.
filled
out our registration blanks and attended several lectures; also
tests in English and mathematics were taken. do not mean that the whole day should be spent on one assignment, but do it carefully and thoroughly. The target was kept moving while the men try to demolish it with a
placement
I
7.
8.
well-placed shot.
The
9.
twins were not identical; one
There
10.
is little
is
larger than the other.
However, why should
enthusiasm shown by the students.
they?
Exercise 3,
Mixed
Rewrite the following sentences.
constructions.
be afraid to break them up
Do
not
they can be improved in that manner.
if
There are today possibly two ways of evaluating the Alcan Highway either as a merchant in Canada or Alaska who sees in it as a source of income or a tourist. Concentration upon what I have been doing has been a bad point because my mind is always wandering about thinking of other things. The dust storms had blown the topsoil off the farms was the reason they had become uneconomical to operate. When parents hand out the money whenever their child wants it, is
1.
2.
3.
4.
contributing to the future unhappiness of their son.
The reason movies are so popular is due to their low cost and You may notice an old hound dog lying on the ground and
5. 6.
quality.
looks as
if
he were asleep.
We
7.
were constantly giving group to come.
our
parties that
we never
asked anyone outside
little
8.
The
9.
and a disgrace to work. Is it true what they are saying about her? The more advanced one goes into a subject, the more
10.
ladies of a century
ago thought
it
necessary to lead a
life
of leisure
interesting
it
be-
comes.
PARALLEL STRUCTURE 35a.
Ideas of equal value
in
a sentence should be expressed
in
parallel structure. It is true that
but
when
it
we do
not always need
can be used,
it
is
strict structural parallelism,
a handy device by which the sen-
tence gains in clearness as well as in force.
In
the device can be explained as a balancing of
noun with noun, an
its
simplest form,
407
35
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
infinitive
with another
a phrase with another phrase,
infinitive,
and a clause with another clause. Let us amples from the work of skilled writers You
first
look at a few ex-
the rulers and the ruled,
are
the lawgivers and the law-abiding, the beginning and the end.
—Adlai
Stevenson
As she passed through the wards
in her plain dress,
so quiet, so
unassuming,
the casual observer simply as the pattern of a perfect lady;
she struck
but
keener
the
eye
perceived
something
more
than
that
the serenity of high deliberation In the scope of the capacious brow,
power
the sign of
in the
dominating curve of the thin nose, and
the traces of a harsh and dangerous temper
something peevish, something mocking, and yet
—
something precise
— from
Eminent Victorians by Lytton Strachey.
of Harcourt, Brace
In
this
in the small
&
Reprinted by permission
Co., Inc.
land the citizens are
to write their plays
and delicate mouth.
still
invited
and books,
to paint their pictures, to
meet
for discussion,
to dissent as well as to agree,
to
mount soapboxes
in the public square,
to enjoy education in all subjects without censorship, to to to
hold court and judge one another,
compose music, talk
politics
with their neighbors without wondering whether the
secret police are listening,
to
exchange ideas as well
to kid the
to read
as goods,
government when real news of
It
needs kidding, and
real events instead of
phony news manufactured by
— E.
B. White,
a paid agent of the state.
"Freedom," One Mans Meat, Harper & Brothers. CopyReproduced by permission of the publisher.
right 1942 by E. B. White.
408
I
35
PARALLEL STRUCTURE
These sentences are written
show what a
they do
The
device
grand manner,
in the
it is
true,
but
can do with parallel structure.
skilled writer
usable at the student level also, as the following
is
examples show: Awkward: Sororities teach a girl to be a lady
[Noun paralleled with
and courteous.
an adjective]
Our
English instructor asked us to close our books, to take pen and paper,
and that we were
Few
[Two
theme.
to write a short
infinitives
and
of the leaders anticipated the bitterness of the strike or
would
a clause]
how
long
it
[A noun and a clause]
last.
Parallel in form: Sororities teach a girl to be
ladylike
and
courteous,
Our
English instructor asked us
[adjective // adjective]
our books,
to close to take
pen and paper, and
to write a short
Few
of the leaders anticipated
theme.
the bitterness or
||
the duration of the strike, II
[noim // noun]
A
35b.
subordinate
which or
joined to a main clause
The "and which"
who
clause should not be carelessly
by and.
who" fault, as it is called, consists of "and who" in a sentence that does not have preceding "which" or "who" clause. or "and
using "and which" or
a
Faulty:
He
is
a
man
wide experience and who
of
is
also very
popular with the
new
and which
farmers. I
am
interested in electronics, because
interesting opportunities to one
is
it
who knows
a
field
offers
science.
Parallel:
He
is
a
man
of
|
wide experience and great popularity
among
the farmers.
I
I
am
interested in electronics
which which
is
a
new
field
and
offers interesting opportunities
409
35
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
— using parallel —should be avoided.
The false parallel
35c.
that
is,
structure for ideas
that are not parallel
and awkward:
Illogical I
realized
finally
my daydreaming was not making me beautiful, [The three words seem to depend on making me, but
that
slender, or friends.
two of them are adjectives and one
is
They
a noun.
are not logically
parallel.]
She has black She has black
hair, blue eyes,
hair, blue eyes,
and is very fair. and wears glasses.
Revised: I
finally realized
that
slender or bringing
She has black
me
my
me
daydreaming was not making
and
beautiful
friends.
and a very
hair, blue eyes,
fair
complexion.
[Series of three
nouns]
She has black hair and blue eyes, and she wears glasses. [Put the and between the two which are similar. Put the third into a separate clause.]
may be
Parallel forms
both
.
and,
.
.
either
used with the correlative conjunctions
.
,
.
neither
or,
Care should be taken
but also.
that the intended
meaning
.
.
.
nor,
not
only
.
.
.
in placing these correlatives so
of the sentence
is
not obscured.
Exercise Exercise
In the following sentences underline the parts that should be
1.
expressed in parallel form. 1.
Vem and
is
Then
rewrite each sentence.
a large boy, blonde hair, very large nose, deep-set blue eyes,
his white teeth flash
when he
smiles.
2.
After I graduated from high school I debated whether to go on to
3.
It
college or is
if I
should enlist at once.
important to analyze these three types of radio broadcasts with
a view to purpose, presentation, 4.
We
try to teach
habits, 5.
and how
them how to get the
6.
In the evening
life.
openings, one for general use and there
can be used
we would
along with people, table manners, good
most from
Chipmunk burrows have two also another one that
and how they are sponsored.
to get
in case of
is
emergency.
play baseball, pitch horseshoes, or some other
type of outdoor game. 7.
My
work
telephone.
410
in his office consisted of typing addresses
and
to
answer the
36
COMPARISONS His students are
8.
taken seriously or
still
if
wondering whether
his advice
was meant
to be
he was merely joking.
The natives are both afraid and they are suspicious also. They do not know whether to hide or if they should co-operate with
9.
10.
us.
COMPARISONS 36a,
In
standard formal English, compartsons should be logical and
complete.
Written English, especially formal written English, requires a
and a
logic
precision in expressing comparisons that
in loose, informal speech.
Some
comparisons have become idiomatic.
illogical
ened comparisons, or
and more common
is
often lacking
In informal speech certain
illogical
elliptical or
of these short-
comparisons, are becoming more
in writing, both formal
other cases of divided usage, the choice
and informal; as
made by
in
the student should
be based on an understanding of the facts of usage.
In informal writing do not omit than or as in a double com-
1.
parison. Usually inappropriate in formal usage: Agriculture
now
is
as important,
if
not more important than mining,
[as
important than mining?]
Clark
The
is
as fast
salaries
if
not faster than Harrison,
[as fast
earned by college graduates vary as
than Harrison?]
much
if
not
more than
those earned by high-school graduates.
Logical but awkward: Agriculture
Clark
The
is
is
now
as fast as,
salaries
if
as important as,
if
not more important than mining.
not faster than Harrison.
earned by college graduates vary as
much
as, if
not more than
those earned by high-school graduates.
The
last
three examples illustrate
pended construction."
Some
the score of awkwardness.
It
what
writers use
can be
is
it;
often called the "susothers object to
it
on
easily avoided.
411
36
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
Logical and smooth: Agriculture
Clark
The
is
salaries
graduates,
Do
2.
now
is
as important as mining,
as fast as Harrison,
if
if
not more
so.
not faster.
graduates vary as
college
of
if
much
those of high-school
as
not more.
not omit one term of a comparison.
Misleading: I admire him more than Scott. The United States helped Russia more than England.
Clear: I
admire him more than
I
admire Scott (or more than Scott does). Russia more than England did {or more than
The United States helped we helped England).
Do
3.
not omit other after than or as in comparing two
bers of the
same group or
mem-
class.
Misleading:
Kowalski
is
heavier than any
teani, the sentence
is
clear.
man on If
he
is
the team.
a
member
[If
Kowalski
is
not on the
of the team, he cannot be
heavier than himself.] Clear:
Kowalski
is
heavier than any other
Kowalski
is
the heaviest
man on
man on
the team.
the team.
4. Finish your comparisons so that you will not seem to be comparing something that you do not intend to compare.
Misleading:
The
salary of an English teacher
is
lower than a lawyer.
[Are you com-
paring salaries, or are you comparing salary and lawyer?]
The duties and game warden.
responsibilities of a traffic officer are
more complex than
a
Clear:
The
salary of an English teacher
desire
412
to
escape
is
lower than that of a lawyer,
awkwardness you should not
say,
"An
[In your
English teacher
36
COMPARISONS earns less than a lawyer." logical in expression,
does a lawyer, but he gets
The
and
duties
If
you want
you could
say,
"An
to be accurate in fact as well as
English teacher earns
more than
less."]
responsibilities
[Name
of a traffic officer are
more complex than
those of a
game warden.
36b,
standard English, con^parisons are completed except
In
the second term of the comparison.!
when
the missing term of the comparison can be easily supplied
by Not It
clear:
remain
easier to
is
silent
when
made upon
attacks are
the things one
[Easier than what?]
loves.
who
Students live
the reader.
live in a
[Better than students
dormitory do better work.
who
where?]
Clear: It
is
remain
easier to
silent
when
attacks are
made upon
the things one
loves than to risk criticism by defending them.
who
Students private
homes
There
dormitory do better work than those
live in a
{or
who
live in fraternity
unfinished comparison better to it
tell
the truth"
wiser to agree."
Uke these. speech, as in:
many
however,
are,
is ;
No
in
idiomatic expressions in which an
easily understood,
"her explanation
misunderstanding
The uncompleted
who room
houses).
superlative
is
is is
such as: "It simpler"
;
is
always
"we thought
possible in statements also used, especially in
and its sense is not that of a comparison but of an intensive, "She is the most unselfish woman," "he is a most peculiar
man."
We
must
refers to
also add here that although in general a comparati\e two and a superlative refers to three or more, idiomatically
the superlative
is
use of the superlative in
two persons or objects.^ This undoubtedly more common in speech than
often used with is
formal writing.
'George O. Curme, Syntax, p. 504; Robert C. Pooley, Teaching EngHsk 119-123; Bergen Evans and Cornelia Evans, A Dictionary of Contemporary American Usage, pp. 105-107. Usage, pp.
413
37
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
Exercise Exercise
Revise the comparisons in the following sentences.
1.
Use
the
forms appropriate in standard written English.
When
you compare the father's and mother's influence on a child, that mother is always strongest and most lasting. The terms which McVey recommended were as liberal if not more
1.
of the
2.
liberal
than those originally asked for by the unions.
supposed to be one
3.
It is
4.
Morry, their captain,
5.
On
Saturday night more
He
is
6.
of, if
not the hardest course in the university.
as fast,
is
men
if
not faster than any
study their lessons than
man on
their team.
girls.
scorned by the intellectuals, but his poems arc better
known than
any poet in America. Girls are
7.
probably better in flattering their teachers than the best of
the male effort.
His step was as light as many middle-aged men. They have raised their standard of living to
8. 9.
a point higher than any
place on earth.
Our new
10.
professor
themes, and he
WORDS
LEFT
is
the darlingest
is
Two
such a dear about late
for clearness should not
be
left out.
kinds of omissions need be considered here.
The
result of carelessness.
reading.
The second
is
cure for that type
clipped or telegraphic cially serious
and
more
is
One
is
the
careful proof-
the omission that results from the carrying
We
over of speech habits into writing.
The
is
OUT
Words necessary
37.
man; he
so liberal with his grades.
manner than
dignified writing
on
is
often speak in a
more
permissible in writing, espe-
serious subjects.
following are some of the omissions that need to be guarded
against
MISLEADING OMISSION OF THAT.
7.
Misleading: I
soon observed nearly
were carrying strange the
all
little
the
women,
baskets.
especially the
young and pretty ones,
[Did he "observe the women, especially
young and pretty ones^" or did he observe that the
baskets?]
414
women were
carrying
WORDS He
me
told
is
his story in
its
undesirable even
if it is
told
me
37
OUT
had been rejected by
original version
He
[Supply that.
publishers.
LEFT
that his story
....
The
thirteen
confusion
but momentary.]
OMISSION OF A PART OF A VERB OR VERB PHRASE.
2.
Misleading:
The is
patient
was given an anesthetic and the instruments made ready. [It made ready, because patient is singular, and the verb
better to say were
following
ments
is
it
made
cannot be understood with instruments
ready.
Instru-
plural.]
His ideas were progressive and adopted without debate.
The two
The
verbs are not parallel.
the second were
is
first
were
is
[Repeat were.
used as a main verb;
an auxiliary verb, or a part of the verb phrase were
adopted.]
OtMSSION OF V/ORDS V/H1CH WOULD MAKE A PARALLEL
3.
SERIES INTELLIGIBLE. Confused:
He
about fifty-nine years old, gray hair, and very distinctive features.
is
b gray
[He
hair?]
Improved:
He
is
about fifty-nine years old.
features.
4.
He
has gray hair and very distinctive
[Supply the necessary verb.]
NOUNS OR
VERBS
UNDERSTOOD
IN
A DOUBLE CAPACITY.
Illogical:
A
Raisin in the
Sun
is
one of the
[This sort of construction ever,
many
is
people object to
very it.
best, if
common Some
not the best play
I
have ever seen.
in speech; in written English,
writers have used
how-
it.]
Improved:
A
Raisin in the Sun
is
one of the best plays that
I
have ever seen,
if
not the
best.
5.
OMISSION OF IDIOMATIC PREPOSITIONS.
Incomplete:
Winter term a new course winter term .] .
.
in chemistry will
be offered.
[Say During the
.
415
38
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES a good time to show your faith and devotion to your country.
This
is
faith
in,]
Customers have neither respect nor
faith in a
merchant who
cheats.
[Say
[Say
respect for.]
For a more complex sentence in which idiomatic prepositions are used with precise care, examine the following sentence taken
from Galsworthy's essay on drama. This third method requires a certain detachment; with, a love of, and a curiosity as
to,
it
things for their
requires a sympathy
own
sake;
it
requires
a far view, together with patient industry, for no immediately practical results.
Exercise Exercise
1.
Supply the missing words
arrange the wording wherever 1.
Being able
to write well
being turned
down
in
the
following sentences.
Re-
necessary.
it is
may mean
the difference between obtaining
and
a job.
4.
Some men never have and never will understand generosity. He was one of the first, if not the first man taught by the Wright brothers how to fly a plane. The prisoner protested tearfully that he was innocent and he was being
5.
A
2. 3.
mistaken for someone
else.
fraternity house or a dormitory
have
is
a question which
many freshmen
to answer.
VARIETY 38,
Variety
makes
A
writer
in
the length
writing
may
more
and
the structure of sentences usually
effective,
avoid monotony of sentence structure by avoiding
the following
1.
Beginning a
2.
Beginning a
series of sentences series of sentences
3.
Using the same sentence pattern
4.
Beginning each of a clause,
416
with the same word or the same subject;
with participial phrases; in a
group of sentences;
series of sentences
with the same kind of subordinate
:
VARIETY
38
Notice the monotony of the sentence patterns in the following excerpts from student papers: Short sentences beginning with a participial phrase: After cleaning up,
we
lay
down and went
to sleep.
Upon
awakening,
we
heard a mocking bird singing beautifully. Looking out the window, we could see it perched on a limb of a magnolia tree. Feeling much better
by
this time,
we decided
Short sentences,
My
to dress
and go out
in search of adventure.
beginning with the subject:
all
roommate has some very good
She spends most of her study traits. She always has her work done, for she is quite studious. She is very good at giving good advice. She keeps me well informed as to She, being a sophomore, knows the the college rules and regulations. She knows each member of the students and the professors quite well. football team personally. She is what is termed a campus "big shot." time in the library.
may be expressed
The
principle
simple sentences with complex or
in positive
form
1.
Mix
2.
Put a short sentence in the midst of several long ones;
3.
Occasionally begin a sentence with modifiers instead of with the subject;
4.
Occasionally begin with a conjunction instead of with the subject.
compound
sentences;
Observe the pleasing variety of sentences in the following para-
graph from a freshman paper.
During the scorching summer of 1959 I was invited by Russell Towboat and Mooring Company to work in their confectionary at the ferry boat depot, [prepositional phrase] [short sentence] I was thrilled at the thought, Therefore I asked not what my salary would be, what hours I would work, or what my little task would be I accepted, [begins with conjunction] My salary was an enormous fifty cents an hour; I worked a split shift, from six to eight in the morning and from three to five in the afternoon; and my task, not at all little, was selling everything from steaming cups of Maxwell House to trip tickets three for a quarter, nine cents apiece, [long compound sentence] Worse yet was the fact that I pedaled daily to and from work on an old, broken-down single-tired Champion, [begins with adjective]
—
—
More
appropriately should I have been called the champion, for I not only traveled three hilly miles each trip but also lugged along Drd'ersua-
hesitates to
In another sense,
vague and redundant.
Poor: Have you any Better:
Bet-
interest-
Have you any
inter-
wrote epics and other poems along
wrote epics and other narrative poems.
settle, it is
more appropriate
in informal
use.
Widely used colloquially
number, a large amount, a great
454
is
and often
in the line of groceries.
ing books in the line of fiction? esting novels?
slang.
is
it
the following examples,
Poor: ter:
number
is
groups of meanings given in Webster's
International: "characteristic form of glib, sive,
line
for
deal.
many, much, a large Colloquial:
He
has a
44
A GLOSSARY OF USAGE exceptions
of
lots
many .) Mad. Colloquially mad .
usage
.
it
He
{Formal:
lot to learn.
to
much
has
this
There are
to leam.)
There
{Formal:
rule.
are
.
is
In formal
used in the sense of angry.
means "insane."
when used with measures of quantity, time, The appropriate word is most. Example: Most of day {not The majority of the day) we stood in line and Inaccurate
Majority.
distance.
the
waited.
Might
Illiterate for
of.
Most, almost.
might have.
Most, in formal written English,
form of much or many.
Examples:
Much
is
food,
most food; many men, more men, most men. adverb meaning "nearly." substituted for almost.
men have most
is
the superlative
more
Almost
In colloquial use most
Formal: almost {not most)
returned from Korea.
frequently used to quahfy
is
all
food, is
an
often of our
In conversational usage, all,
everyone, everybody,
anyone, anybody, always. Neither, nor; either, or.
Neither should be followed by nor; either
should be followed by
Both neither and
or.
either
may
be
used with more than two alternatives, as: Either past, present, or future
Nice.
A
to
See Nicholson, p. 362.
vague word of mild approval. In informal speech
writing.
No
....
it is
Use sparingly
appropriate
in serious
when you mean
be vague and mild.
good, no-good.
Colloquial
when used
for worthless, useless, o]
no value.
Nowhere
near, nowheres near.
Webster's
New
Labeled archaic and dialectal in
International Dictionary.
In writing and in
more or less formal speech it is better to use not nearly. Example: That was not nearly {not nowhere near) as much as he had expected. O, Oh. O is used with another word, a substantive, usually in direct address. It is always capitaHzed and is not followed by any mark of punctuation. Oh is an exclamation, not capitalized except when it begins a sentence, and is followed by either a
comma
or an exclamation point.
455
44 Off
A GLOSSARY OF USAGE The
of.
Example: Please
unnecessary.
is
of
He
that ladder.
off of)
{not
get off
took the book off {not off of) the
shelf.
Out
Labeled colloquial by
loud.
WNID.
Standard forms, good
both formal and informal situations,
in
Example: He
loudly, audibly.
Outside
loud,
When
Example:
Colloquial for except, besides.
of.
aloud,
are
called aloud for help.
the
robbery occurred, the policeman saw no one except {not out-
mailman on
side of) the
Over Party.
it
the street.
In the sense of finished, ended,
with.
Except in legal and telephone means "a person."
Per cent.
It
may
it
usage,
it is
The
be used after numbers.
colloquial.
is
when
colloquial
sign
%
not used
is
except after figures in tabulations or in technical writing. is
not an exact synonym for percentage.
Examples:
A
It
high
Only ten per cent But Evans and Evans say (or percent) are self-supporting. there is no difference in meaning between the two words percentage of the population
(p.
is illiterate.
363). Colloquial
Plenty.
when used
as
an adverb
in
such expressions as
plenty good, plenty good enough, plenty rich, before a noun.
adjective
The room
Colloquial:
etc.,
He was
or as an
plenty rich.
wood for another fire. Formal: He was very rich. The room is large enough. There is enough wood for another fire. Ten dollars is plenty. There
plenty large.
is
is
plenty
See A.M., a.m.
P.IM.
Poorly.
Colloquial for in poor health, not well, unwell.
Practicable,
practical.
feasible, usable."
perienced." practicable
Practical
means "something possible, means "useful, not theoretical, ex-
may
apply to persons, things, ideas;
Practicable
Practical
may
not apply to persons.
Proposition, proposal.
See
WDS,
page 639.
Proposal implies a direct and explicit act
of proposing; proposition implies a statement or principle for discussion.
The
loose
use
of
proposition
to
thing, a task, a business enterprise, a problem,"
456
many
people.
tion)
to study until three in the
Examples:
It is
mean is
"idea,
disliked
by
a poor practice {not proposi-
morning.
Moving
the
set-
.
44
A GLOSSARY OF USAGE out of the
tiers
osition
Two
Quiet, quite.
with
words
it
may
rise.
Two
You
He
mean
"very, to a con-
quite friendly.
The
verbs often confused.
principal parts are:
Rise:
Raise: 1 raise
In in-
are quite right.
also be used to
The dog seems
siderable degree."
Quiet has to do
In formal standard usage, quite
completely."
"entirely,
formal usage
Raise,
carelessly confused.
or calmness.
stillness
means
was an impractical plan {not prop-
district
)
my
hand.
raised the
They have
I rise in the
morning
They rose before They had risen at
window.
raised the flag.
I did.
sunrise.
Colloquial as an adverb in the sense of really or very.
Real.
was
Colloquial: His playing citing
game.
real brilliant.
Formal: His playing was
It
was a
really
real ex-
brilUant.
It
was a very exciting game. Reason is because, reason is on account of. In informal speech, such constructions as "The reason I came to college was because I wanted to study engineering" are common, and they occur occasionally in writing.
Some educated
persons con-
and speech; them on two counts: they are wordy and
sider the expressions established in both writing
others object to repetitious,
and they are
slovenly.
It is
well to learn
how
to
avoid them.
Awkward: The reason
they were defeated was because the field was
wet.
The The
reason he was late was because the roads were blocked. reason for
my
poor work
in English
is
due
to
my
poor high-school
preparation.
The
reason
I
can't spell
on account of
is
never learned
I
how
in high
school.
Revised: They were defeated because the
He was
My I
late
poor work
am
field
was wet.
because the roads were blocked. in English
is
a poor speller because
I
due
to
my
poor high-school preparation.
did not learn
how
to spell in high school.
457
44
A GLOSSARY OF USAGE In the sense of very,
Right.
it
dialectal.
is
Example: He was
a very (no^ right) good speaker.
Same, such. Appropriate in legal documents. In ordinary speech and writing, it is better to use it, this, that. Example: Please repair the camera and ship it (^not same) to me tomorrow. Seldom ever, seldom or ever. The correct idioms are seldom,, very seldom., hardly ever, Set,
Two
sit.
seldom
if
ever.
Learn the principal parts:
verbs often confused.
down;
down; now he
sits down; I sat down; they have sat down. But of course one may speak of a setting hen, and the sun sets, not sits. You may set the cup on the shelf and then sit down. I sat on the stool after I had set the cup down. Shape. Colloquial for condition. Colloquial: The athlete was in excellent shape. Formal: The equipment was in very good
I set it
have
I
set it
condition {not shape).
As a conjunction between main
So.
clauses, so
much
is
Usually the primary fault
in student writing.
much
ordination instead of too
is
too
overused little
sub-
Examples: The
use of so.
up during the night, and so the attack was delayed. The attack was delayed because the bridge had been blown up during the night. The Russians were not ready, so they waited until August to declare war on Japan. bridge was blown
Since the Russians were not ready, they waited until August to declare
war on Japan.
In clauses of purpose, the standard subordinating conjunction
so that, as in
is
:
They
flew low so that they could observe
the results of the bombing.
But so
is
also used, especially in
spoken English. 6*0 as
a "feminine intensive" can be easily overworked in
—and
speech ever. is
Such.
it
often
is.
Examples: She
is
has a long Hterary tradition, how-
so kind
and
so charming.
The work
so hard.
As an
intensive,
Teaching English clause of result
is
it
is
used
like
awful or
so.
See Pooley,
Usage, pp. 96-98. Such introducing a followed by that. Example: There was
such an explosion that
458
It
it
could be
felt
for
twenty miles.
44
A GLOSSARY OF USAGE
When
introducing a
relati\'e
Example: Such amendments
clause, such
as
you may
followed by
is
as.
stipulate will be in-
cluded in the contract.
Formal: This
Colloquial for certainly, surely, indeed.
Sure.
certainly {not suvt)
Dialectal
Suspicion.
an
interesting
when used
storv'.
The standard form
as a verb.
Example: We suspected something was wrong.
suspect.
suspicioned)
{not
is
that
Slang
Colloquial for stylish, fashionable, smartly clothed.
Swell.
is
and a host of Examother words expressing approval or commendation. swell) evening. It Ls a ples: AVe had an enjoyable {not a for excellent, very good, interesting, enjoyable,
{not a swell
thrilling
Take stock
we
ample: Can
That
)
game.
Colloquial for accept, believe, put faith
in.
Illiterate forms.
there, this here, etc.
are that,
Their
The standard forms
An
To, too, two. too should It's
is
a possessive pronoun.
Example: They're happy because
"they are."
Try and,
Ex-
this, these, those.
Their, they're.
spell.
in.
believe {not take stock in) his promises?
elementary spelling problem.
make two
They're means
team won. Example: He
their
dicdonary to learn
how
to
International labels try
and
as
trips to the
not too hard.
try to.
Webster's
colloq. for try to,
New
but Pooley (pp. 132-133) points out that
and has a long and respectable history. Very, very much. Many educated persons object try
of very
much
a verb phrase.
ticiple in
of
its
to very instead
or very greatly as a modifier of a verb or a par-
Other persons point out examples
use in the works of reputable writers.
See the note
New International. Examples: They They were ven' much pleased. They seemed very disturbed. They seemed ver}- greatly disturbed. Wait on. Regional for wait for, stay for. Standard in the sense under very in Webster's
were very pleased.
of attend,
perform services
for, as:
It
was the other
girl
who
waited on me.
Want
in,
come
want in,
out,
want
to
want
off,
etc.
go out, want
Dialectal forms for
want
to
to get off, etc.
459
44
A GLOSSARY OF USAGE
Way, ways. -
-
Way
colloquial for condition.
is
Formal:
for distance, way.
bad health {not
in
We
a bad way.)
we rested. The at is unnecessary. Where at is he now?)
Ways
When we saw
is
dialectal
him. he was in
walked a long distance
{not ways) before
Where
at.
{not
While.
Example: Where
Frequently overused as a conjunction.
or whereas would be more precise. of at the
same time
It is
as or although.
is
he now?
Usually but, and,
standard in the sense
It is colloquial in
the
sense of whereas.
Without.
You
460
all.
Dialectal for unless.
In Southern speech, you
all is
the plural
form of you.
INDEX TO QUOTED PASSAGES QUOTATIONS
IDENTIFIED HERE BY
AUTHOR ONLY
ARE USUALLY VERY BRIEF.
Adams, James Truslow, 268 Frederick Lewis, The Big Change, 79-80, 95-96, 300 Aydelotte, Frank, "What the American Rhodes Scholar Gets from OxAllen,
Carlyle,
Thomas, 270
Churchill, Winston, Blood, Sweat, Tears, 18-19, 359-360 Ciardi, John, "What Does It Enjoy a Poem." 90
ford," 399
Bacon, Francis, 69 Owen, History in English Words, 269 Barnard, Ellsworth, Edwin Arlington Robinson, 300 Bede's Ecclesiastical History, 2, 17 Bellamy, Edward, The Duke of Stockbridge, 305 Barfield,
Belloc, Hilaire, Hills
and
the Sea,
57-
Clark, Colin, Taxes," 143
and
Take
to
"The Danger Point
in
Clemens, Samuel L. (Mark Twain), The Adventures of Huckleberry Finn, 26 Cobb, Irwin S., 278 Cole, William Morse, "The Profession of Accounting," 136-137
Commager, Henry
Steele, see Nevins,
Allan Conant,
58 Bennett, Arnold. 310
David S., "An Agreement of Subject and Verb in Anticipatory There Clauses," 218 Bible, quotations from, 9-10 Bowen, Catherine Drinker, John Adams and the American Revolution, 310; Yankee from Olympus,
Berkeley,
306 Brooks,
Carson, Rachel, The Edge of the Sea, 312; The Sea Around Us, 282
Van Wyck, 291-292; Opin-
ions of Oliver Allston, 308; Scenes Portraits, 106
and
Brown, John, last speech, 18 Brown, John Mason, Through These Men, 306 Bryant, Margaret M., Modern English and Its Heritage, 32 Burke, Thomas, The Wind and the Rain, 368
James B., Modern Science and Modern Man, 87—88 Conrad, Joseph, Lord Jim, 72, 366 Constable, W. G., "Three Stars for Baedeker," 141 Cowie, Alexander, The Rise of the American Novel, 314 Cronin, A, J., The Green Years, 355
Cummings, E. E., The Enormous Room, 355-356 Curme, George D., Syntax, 413, 445, 449 Curtis,
George WilHam, 359
Daiches, David, 311
A
Study
of Literature,
DeQuincey, Thomas, 270 DeVoto, Bernard, 360 Drucker,
Peter F.,
"How
to
Be an
Employee," 115-116 Caen, Herb, see Yavno, Cargill,
Oscar,
294, 308
Max
Intellectual
America,
Edman,
Irwin,
"Fashions in
Ideas,"
278
461
INDEX Evans, Bergen, and Cornelia Evans, A Dictionary of Contemporary American Usage, 241, 413, 442, 453 Faulkner, William, Nobel Prize Award Speech, 19-20 Firkins, Oscar W., 70 Forbes, Esther, Paul Revere and the
World He Lived M., mocracy, 69 Fortune, 314
Forster,
E.
In, 83, 313, 314
Two
Cheers for De-
Gallic©, Paul, 312 Galsworthy, John, Candelabra, "Some
Platitudes Concerning Drama," 94 Gibbs, Wolcott, 292 Gildersleeve, Virginia C, Many a
Kluckhohn, Clyde, Mirror for Man, 94-95 Krapp, George P., The Knowledge of English, 269, 271 Krutch, Joseph Wood, 278, 286; "Is
Common Man Too Common?"
278; 98; Confessions Writer," 22; The
The Great Chain of "Some Unsentimental
Life,
a Nature Twelve Seasons, 418-419
of
Leacock, Stephen, "Lost in the Jungle of Economics," 142 Lewis, Sinclair, Main Street, 205 Lincoln, Abraham, Second Inaugural Address, 18 Lynes, Russell, "The New Snobbism," 144, 148
Good Crusade, 104 E. Thomas, "New Guinea's Rare Birds and Stone Age Men," 75-76 Gunther, John, Inside Russia Today, 88-89 Gilliard,
McGinley, Phyllis, "Ladies on the Highway," 128 McLaverty, Michael, School for Hope, 278 Marshall, Bruce, 280 Masters, Edgar Lee,
Hale, Nancy, 366 Hall, H. Tracy, "Ultrahigh Pressures,"
Margaret, With Malice Toward Some, 354, 366
Halsey,
Harper's Magazine, 218 Frederic,
Memories
and
Thoughts, 218 Hawthorne, Nathaniel, The Scarlet Letter, 90-91 Hemingway, Ernest, In Our Time, 56 Highet, Gilbert, The Art of Teaching, 80-81 Hockett, Charles F., A Course in Modern Linguistics, 286 Hoover, Herbert, The Memoirs of Herbert Hoover, 89 Hoyle, Fred, "The Sun and the Stars," 143, 148 Huff, Darrell, "How to Lie with Statistics," 144, 147 Huxley, Thomas Henry, 312
Agnes Newton, Three Came Home, 354 Kennedy, John F., Profiles in CourKeith,
age, 283
462
Maugham, W.
Somerset,
The Sum-
ming Up, 283
148
Harrison,
The Sangamon,
283
Mauldin, Bill, Up Front, 26-27 Mead, Margaret, And Keep Your Powder Dry, 289 Meiklejohn, Alexander, 298 Mencken, H. L., The American Language, 85 Mott, Frank Luther,
Golden Multi-
tudes, 271, 299
Mumford, Lewis, 286 Mytinger, Caroline, 366 Nevins, Allan, and
Henry
Steele
Com-
mager. The Pocket History of the United States, 85, 86 New York Times Magazine, "To the Planets and Beyond," 93 Nicholson, Margaret, A Dictionary of American English Usage, 448, 455
OTlaherty, Liam, Spring Sowing, 355 Page, Elizabeth, 366 Papashvily, George and Helen, Anything Can Happen, 28-29 Pei, Mario. One Language for the World, 143
,
INDEX Perelman, S. J., The Most of S. J. Perelman, 368-369 Phillips, Wayne, 292 Phillips, Wendell, 359 Pooley, Robert C, Teaching English Grammar, 32; Teaching English Usage, 396, 413, 448, 449, 458 Pyle,
Brave Men, Country, 283
Ernie,
Home
Robertson,
E.
376 Rolvaag, O. 280
E,,
Arnot.
The
111-112;
Tharp, Louise Hall, The Peabody Sisters of Salem, 313, 314 Thoreau, H. D., Walden, 17-18 Time, "The Younger Generation," 298 Ulen, Jr.,
Harold
S.,
and Guy Larcom,
The Complete Swimmer, 123
Untermeyer, Louis, 298 Signpost,
Van Doren, Mark, The Autobiography of Mark Van Doren, 105-106
Giants in the Earth,
Vergara, William C., Science in Everyday Things, 82-83, 298
Education and the 66-67; In Praise of Idleness and Other Essays, 60-61
Russell, Bcrtrand,
Good
Life,
Santayana,
George,
Persons
and
Places, 289, 419
Schlesinger, Arthur M.,
The Age
of
Jackson, 284 Spring, Howard, The Houses in Between, 91-92 Stefansson, Vilhjalmur, Hunters of the Great North, 123-124 Steinbeck, John, Cannery Row, 110, 368; The Grapes of Wrath, 355 Stevenson, Adlai, 70-71, 408 Stewart, George R., Fire, 75 Strachey, Lytton, 211; Eminent Victorians,
408; Queen Victoria, 218
Walker, C. Lester, "The Man Who Makes Weather," 144 Walker, Stanley, "Everything's True About Texas," 142, 149 Wells, H. G., Mr. Britling Sees It Through, 278 White, E. B., "Calculating Machine," 23-24; One Man's Meat, 408; "Notes and Comment," 70-71 Wilson, Edmund, Axel's Castle, 311 Wilson, Woodrow, 359 Wolfe, Of Time and the River, 72,
108-109 Woolf, Virginia, Between 367; The Death of a
America, 82. 84
Autumn
Across
Acts,
Other Essays, 108-109 WyclifiFe,
Taylor, Jeremy, 73 Teale, Edwin Way.
the
Moth and
John, 9
Yavno, Max, and Herb Caen, San Francisco Book, 125
Thi
463
INDEX ALL
NUMBERS
A, an, the,
REFER
TO PAGES.
articles, classified as adjec-
tives,
35
A, an, proper use
differentiated, of,
440
Abbreviations:
AD.
and B.C., 364
anon., for anonymous, 176 capitalization of, 261
176 column, columns, 176 e.g., for example, 176 honorary titles before names, 263 ibid., ibidem, 176 i.e., that is, 176 in bibliography, 176 ch., chap., chapter,
col., cols.,
263 176 names of governmental agencies,
list
of usual abbreviations, cit.,
264 176 punctuation with, 277 Reverend, Honorable, not abbreviated, 264 technical terms, 264 op.
cit.,
when
permissible,
263-264
with proper names, 263 when not followed by period, 318 words usually not abbreviated: Christian names, 264 miscellaneous list, 264
names names names Above,
as
264 264 of days, months, 264 reference word, 385 of college courses,
of countries, states,
Absolute phrases, commas with, 291 not dangling, 393 Abstract noun, defined, 34 Abstract word, defined, 353 Absurdity in writing, unintentional, 405 Accent, ascent, assent, defined, 330
464
440
Accordingly, conjunctive adverb, 298 Active to passive, shift, 400 Active voice, for emphasis, 397 Ad., for advertisement, 440 A.D., proper use of, 264 Address of a letter: inside address, 192 forms to be used, 192 punctuation of, 192 Adjective clauses, diagrams of, 51 punctuation with, 50 restrictive
and
nonrestrictive, 50
structural signals with, 50
in footnotes, 176
loc.
Accept, except, defined, 330
Adjectives, defined, 35
diagrams of, 42-46, 238 with copulative verbs, 237 with sensory verbs, 237 wrong use of noun form, 237 Adjectives and adverbs, 236-241 adverb, to modify verb, adjective, adverb, 238
comparison of, 240-241 comparative degree, 240 superlative degree, 240 forms of, 236-237 similarity in form, 236-237 two forms of, 239-240 Adjectives, co-ordinate, punctuation with, 284 Admittance, admission, defined, 330 Adverbial clauses, diagrams of, 52 functions of, 51-52 Adverbial phrases, restrictive and nonrestrictive, 288 Adverbs, see also Adjectives and adverbs
240 comparative forms, 240
classes of,
defined, 31
diagrams
of,
42-46
INDEX distinguished from adjectives, 236-
237 forms of, 236 functions of, 36, 236 misplaced, 387-388 position of, in sentence, superlative forms, 240
387-388
used as conjunctions, 36-37 words modified by, 36, 238 Affect, effect, defined, 330 differentiated, 440 Aggravate, two meanings of, 441 Agree to, agree with, proper uses
Altar, alter, defined, 330 of,
441
Agreement ent,
pronoun with anteced231-233
of
collective noun,
number, gender, 231
pronoun in apposition, 233 who, whose, which, uses of, 233 with each, every, everybody, everyone, either, neither,
etc.,
231-
232 see also Pronouns, Antecedents, Reference of pronouns of subject
and verb, 215-
222 collective noun,
compound
220
subject
joined
by and,
218 introductory it, 217 not with subjective complement,
218 plural subject, 215, 218 plural word intervening, 216 relative pronoun, plural, 221
subject after verb, 217-218 there is, there are, 217 title of book, etc., 220
with each, every, each one, everyone, everybody, anybody, nobody, either, neither, 219 with neither-nor, either-or, 219 words added by as well as, together with, with, in addition to, except, no less than, 216
words ending
in
-s,
221
Agricultural Index, listed, 162
nonstandard use, 441 introducing summary, how punc-
Ain't, All,
tuated, 312
all
together, defined, 442
A.M., a.m., P.M., p.m., 261 proper use of, 442 punctuation with, 277 reference, to be avoided,
382
one as antecedent, 233
Agreement
Altogether,
Ambiguous
232
differences in usage, 231 in person,
used as summarizing word, for clearness, 432 Allow, for assert, say, think, believe, dialectal, 441 All ready, already, defined, 441 All the farther, all the faster, 441 Allude, refer, differentiated, 441 Allusion, illusion, defined, 441 Almost, misplaced, 388 Already, all ready, defined, 441 Alright, nonstandard, 441 All,
Americana Annual, listed, 158 American College Dictionary, speci-
men
from, 341
Among, between, proper use of, 442 Amount, number, proper use of, 442 An, a, see A, an, the Analogy, used in developing paragraphs, 90-91 And, but, so, see Subordination And etc., for etc., and so forth, 442 And which construction, 409 And who construction, 409 Anglo-Saxon Period, 5-6 quotations from: Bede's Ecclesiastical History, Bible, 9 Ante-, anti-, defined, 330
2,
17
Antecedent, defined, 231 Antecedents of pronouns, 231-233 agreement with, in person, number, gender, 386 ambiguous, 382 clause as antecedent, 384 clear,
380
each, everyone, etc. as antecedents,
231 indefinite you, they, 383
in subordinate position, 381 one, 383
reference to an idea, 384 sentence as antecedent, 384 vague, 384
Anybody, anyone, verb with, 219
Any place,
anyplace, for anywhere, 442 correct use of, 442
Anyway, anyways,
465
INDEX Anywheres, everywheres, dialectal, 443 Apostrophes, uses of, 301-303 omitted in titles, 303 to form plurals of figures, letters, 302 to form possessives of: group names (joint possession), 301
224 nouns ending in -s, 302 nouns not ending in -s, 302 to indicate omissions, 302 wrong with possessive of personal pronouns, 302, 226-227 Appear, verb, adjective complement after, 237 Appearance of manuscript, 254-257 Application, letters of, 196-197 Appositive phrase, misused as sentence, 207 indefinite pronouns, 302,
Appositives: as subordination, for better sentences,
64
case of, 233 introductory words with {namely, as, for example) 293 words introducing, 293
such list
of
^
punctuation of: commas with nonrestrictive, 291 dashes with, 292, 311-312 no commas with restrictive, 291 parentheses for, 292, 311 Appropriateness in use of words, 346348 colloquial words and phrases, 346348 slang, 347 Appropriate tone and style, see
Formal English, 16 Informal English, 21 Standard English, 16 Student's choice, 29 Vernacular, 25 Apt, likely, liable, difTerentiated, 443 Arrangement, details in paragraph.
96-97 Order Arrangement, details in sentence. 387-390 adverbs, 387 clauses, 389 phrases, 388 split infinitive, 390 see also
466
squinting modifier, 389 words noraially near each other,
390 Misplaced modifiers 440
see also
Articles, see a, an, the, 35,
Art Index, listed, 162 As, because, differentiated, 443 As, dialectal for that, whether, 443
As ...
..
as, so
as,
.
correct uses
443 As, than, in double comparison, 411 As, as if, like, see Like, 454 of,
Assumed subject tive case,
As well
of infinitive, objec-
230
subject of verb not plural by, 216 as,
made
At, redundant with where, 443 Atlases and gazetteers, listed, 159
Author card, in card catalogue, 153 Auto, clipped forms, 440 Autobiographical incident, writing of, 105-106 examples of, 105-107 Autobiographical sketch, 102—105 Awful, awfully, colloquial uses, 443
Awkwardness and obscurity tences,
how
in sen-
corrected,
420-
421
Awkward
repetition, to be avoided,
358-359 Back
of, in
back
behind, 452
of,
Bad grammar, used
for effect, 26
Badly, colloquial use
of,
444
Balance in sentence, see Parallel structure,
407-410
Balance, rhetorical patterns, 67, 391 see also Parallel structure,
407-410
Balance, use of semicolon with, 299 Balance, rest, remainder, proper use of,
Bank
444
on, colloquial for rely upon, trust,
444
Bartlett's Familiar Quotations, listed,
160 B.C., proper use of,
264
Be, subjunctive forms
of,
249-250
Be, verb, adjective complement with,
237 Because of, see Reason is because, 457 Become, verb, followed by adjective complement, 237
INDEX Beginnings of sentences, varied, 140144 announcing specific phase of sub-
comment on need
of
new
treatment,
titles of, italicized,
Borrowed
143 facts
155
skimming and reading, 170
141
ject,
getting information from, 170 how listed in card catalogue, 152-
showing importance of sub143
ject,
incident out of which discussion arises, 141 intention to refute old idea, 144 pertinent story or anecdote, 142
pointing out fascinating nature of
144
subject,
173 see also Footnotes of,
Brackets, to enclose interpolations, 315 Breaking word at end of line, see
Hyphens Breath, breathe, defined, 331 Brevity, not same as conciseness, 357 Bunch, colloquial for several, a group,
444
questions which your essay answers,
Business letters:
143 Being as, being that, for because, since,
body
of letter, 193-194 closed punctuation, 192
444
complimentary
Beside, besides, uses of, 444
Between, among, proper use
of,
442
9-10 Anglo-Saxon version, 9 King James version, 10 Revised Standard of 1952, 10
Bible, selections from,
Wyclifre-Pur\-ey, 9
BibHographic forms, 166-168, 190 abbreviations in, 176 basic parts, 167 cards for, 166 final arrangement of, 190 MLA Style Sheet, 166 nature of, 166 references to:
books, 168 bulletins, 167
blame
it
on,
444
Blanket words {deal, factor,
line,
majority, proposition) to be avoided, 337 Block form, in letters, 192 Bole, boll, bowl, defined, 330 Boners, to be avoided, 337-338 Book review, informal type, 119
example
of,
Bookish words, defined, 353 examples of, 353 160
list
signature,
194
Bust, busted, bursted, burst, 444 But, punctuation with, 282, 284, 317
But what, but
that,
445
Cacophony,
see Repetition of similar sounds, 362
Euphony and rhythm
of reference,
156
Dewey Decimal
System, 156 Library of Congress System, 156 Cambridge History of American Literature, listed, 160 Cambridge History of English Literature, listed, 160 Can, may, proper uses of, 445 Cannot help but, 445 Can't hardly, as double negative, 445 Capital, capitol, defined, 331 Capitals, uses of, 259-263 abbreviations after names, 261
120
Books, classified
194
heading, 191-192 inside address, 192 letterheads, 191 open punctuation, 192 personal titles in, 192-193 salutation, 193
see also,
newspapers, 168 periodicals, 168 Bibliography, examples of, 190 Biography, reference books, 158-159 on,
close,
faults to avoid, 199
Calculate, reckon, 445 Call numbers, in card catalogue, 155-
encyclopedias, 168
Blame
267
acknowledgment
material,
after colon,
157-
310
days of week, months, 260 Father, Mother, etc., when used as
names, 262
467
INDEX Continued
Capitals fii'st
word
honorary
with intervening expression, 225
of sentence, titles
259
with names, 261
255, 260 line of poetry, 259 in
titles,
names
for object of preposition,
of:
260
with
organizations, 260
particular studies
and
courses,
persons and places, 260 political and geographical divi-
260-261
sions,
proper adjectives and nouns, 260 races and languages, 260 religious terms, 260 ivords not capitalized:
common nouns and
adjectives,
261 general names of studies, 262 my father, my mother, etc., 262 points of compass, directions, 261 Capitals, used for italics in typing, 267 Card catalogue, basic guide to library, 152-156 alphabetical arrangement by author, subject, title, 152-156 numbers, 155-156
Dewey Decimal
System, 156 Library of Congress System, 156 list of books, bulletins, pamphlets, periodicals,
152-156
appositives,
233
defined, 223
229
in prepositional phrase (of
we
226
nominative, uses of: after than,
as.,
225
for subject of verb, 225 for subjective
468
adverb, defined, 48 uses of, 51 co-ordinate: co-ordination of dependent thought, 48, 371 of,
punctuation
men), 230 us, etc.,
287-289 287-289
40-52 of,
282, 298
dangling, 392
224
indefinite pronouns,
it's
adjective, defined, 48
excessive co-ordination, 371
following than, as, 225
me,
Cite, site, sight, defined, 331
Clauses
diagrams
40-42
elliptical clauses, 225,
226-227
adjective, uses of, 50
manu-
declension of pronouns, 223
it's
to express possession,
with indefinite pronoun, 226 who, whom, whose, 224, 225, 229 with gerunds, 227 with inanimate objects, 228 Cause of, on account of, 445 Censor, censure, defined, 331 Century Dictionary, listed, 339 Changes in language, realistic attitude toward, 12-31 Charted, chartered, defined, 331 Choose, chose, defined, 331 Choppy style, 378 Chronological order, in description and narration, 76 in paragraph, 96, 430 Circumlocution, 361
restrictive, 50,
Case:
of,
apostrophe with, 226 double possessive, 228 its and it's, Til
nonrestrictive, 50,
Caret, to indicate insertions in
258
230
adjective, punctuation with:
sample author card, 153 sample subject card, 155 sample title card, 154 script,
infinitive,
possessive case, uses of:
262
diagrams
230
in clauses of comparison, 229
historical periods,
call
objective case, uses of: for direct object, 228 for indirect object, 228
compliment, 226
dangling elliptical, 395 dependent: diagrams of, 48-52 main thought in, 48, 371 for variety in sentence structure,
58-61 misused as sentence, 206
INDEX noun
clauses, uses of,
49
subject, object, subjective
com-
plement, object of preposition, object of verbal, appositive,
49-50 overlapping dependence, 378 principal, see Co-ordinate subordinate, see Dependent substantive clause, see Noun clause Clauses, parenthetical, punctuation of,
290
misplaced modifiers, 387—391 mixed constructions, 404 shift in point of view, 401-404 squinting reference, 382
Coherence in sentences, improved by: parallel structure, 67, 407-410, 433 proper arrangement, 96-97, 429431 proper reference, 380-386 transitions, 97-98, 431 use of connectives,
Clearness and order, in sentences:
awkwardness and obscurity, 420421
Coherence
correlatives,
410
presentation, 135-138
348
mixed constructions, 404 mixed imagery, 405 parallel structure, 67, 407-410 proper arrangement, 387-391 reference of pronouns, 380-386 shift in point of view, 401-405
defined, 348 levels of usage, informal,
Colon, uses
310 between two
Comma
284-285 Cliches, see Trite phrases, 369-370 Clipped word forms, see Ad, 440 for,
Closed punctuation, letter forms, 192 Coarse, course, defined, 331 Clearness, words necessary for, omitted, 413, 414-415 in sentence, punctuation with,
211
Coherence in paragraphs: by forecast of arrangement, 98 by proper arrangement, 96-97, 429431
by use of topic sentence, 85 by use of transitions: conjunctions, 97, 431 directive words, 97 parallel structure,
433
pronouns, 97, 432 repetition of key words, 97, 432 transitional phrases, 97, 431 selection analyzed for, 98 Coherence in sentences, destroyed by:
awkwardness and obscurity, 420-
310-311
fault, see
tence,
splice, see
tence,
Run-together sen-
209-212 Run-together sen-
209-212
corrected by: co-ordinating conjunction, 210 punctuation, 210 subordination, 209 when permissible, 211
Commas,
unnecessary, 315-318
after co-ordinating conjunction. 317
between subject and verb, verb and object, preposition and object, adjective and noun, 316 restrictive elements, 318 short introductory modifiers, 318 with conjunction joining two words, 317 Commas, uses of, 281-297 after absolute phrase, 286, 291 after introductory modifier,
285—
286 for clearness, in series,
284-285, 286
283-284
position with quotation marks, 307 table of uses, 282 to indicate contrast, 287
421
danghng
clauses,
capitalization with, 310
Comma,
commas used
21-30
309-311
before enumeration, formal list, quotation, explanation, 309-
431
transitions,
of,
after salutation in letters, 193
squinting reference, 382 subordination, 58-65, 374
Climax
431-432
theme, see Order of
Colloquial, see Appropriateness, 347-
dangling modifiers, 392-395 destroyed by overloading, 372-373 misplaced modifiers, 387-391
Clearness,
in
modifiers,
392-395
to prevent misreading,
284-285
469
INDEX Commas
Continued
to separate co-ordinate adjectives,
284 to separate co-ordinate clauses,
282-
283 with conjunctive adverbs, 290
Complex
verbs,
237-
sentence, defined, 48
diagrams
291-293 dates, 293-294 dialogue guides, 293 directive phrases, 290 appositives,
mild exclamations, 279-280, 287
287-289 nonrestrictive elements, 286-289 parenthetical elements, 289-290 responsives yes and no, 287 sentence adverbs, 287 nonrestrictive clauses,
substantives in direct address, 293
with adverbial clauses, 286 with figures for clearness, 265 with geographical names and ad-
293-294
with participial phrases, 286 with transposed elements, 287 Common nouns, defined, 34 not capitalized, 261
Compare
to, compare with, defined. 446 Comparison of adjectives and adverbs, 240-241
absolute qualities, in comparisons,
241 Comparison, clauses of, nominative case in, 225 Comparison, used in paragraph development, 88-90 Comparisons, logical and complete,
411-413 divided usage in, 411 logically complete, 411
one term of comparison omitted, 412 superlative with two, 413 suspended construction, 411 than, as omitted, 411 unfinished comparisons, 412—413 Complected, nonstandard use of, 446 Complement, compliment, defined, 331
Complements, see Direct object, 40 Indirect object, 40 Objective complement, 40
470
and sensory
tive
238
to set off:
dresses,
Retained object, 40, 41 Subjective complement, 40, 41 Complements, adjective, after copula-
48-52
of,
structural signs of, 48
types of clauses in: adjective, 50
adverb, 51
noun, 49 Complimentary
Compound diagram
close, in letters, 194 sentence, defined, 48
of,
48
punctuation
of,
298-300
Compound-complex
sentence, defined,
52
example
Compound
53 words, see also Hyphens
of,
classes of, 272-274 hyphens with, 271-274 numbers, 273
possessives of, 301 rules for hyphenating,
274
Conciseness, 357-363 not same as brevity, 357-358 see also
Wordiness
Conclusion, see Ending Conclusions, formal, to be avoided, 145 "Conclusion," undesirable as main division in outline, 139 Concrete details, in description, 110 in paragraph development, 425 Concreteness in diction, 352-356 Concrete noun, defined, 34 Concrete words, defined, 353 examples of, 353 Condition contrary to fact, subjunctive with,
250
Conjugation, verb take, 244-245 Conjunctions, classes of, 36-37 co-ordinating, 37 correlatives, 36 defined,
36-37
so, uses of, 37,
458
subordinating, 37 Conjunctions, for paragraph coherence, 431 Conjunctive adverbs, 36-37 placing of, 37
punctuation with, 37, 290, 298-299
INDEX Consequently, conjunctive adverb,
298
before
Considerable, for considerably, 446 Constructions, in sentences: awkward and obscure, 420-421 dangling, 392-395
mixed, 404 parallel, 67,
scrambled
407-410 405
figures,
383, 387 squinting, 382 Consul, council, counsel, defined, 331 Contact, for communicate with, 446 Continual, continuous, defined, 446 split,
Continually, continuously, defined, 331 Contractions (omissions) apostrophe with, 302 :
in
formal
style,
446
Contrast, defined, 88 in paragraph development, 88 Contrasting sentence elements, commas with, 287 Conventions of formal outline, 138 Co-ordinate adjectives, punctuation
with, 284
commas
with,
282-283 Correlatives, defined, 36 of,
of,
would
311-313
namely,
all that,
that
is,
312
compared with comma and parentheses, 311
for parenthetical elements, 311
how formed on typewriter, 311 misused for other marks, 313 to indicate sudden break, 311 with formal appositive, 292, 312 with formal summary, 312 Data, strata, phenomena, plurals of datum, stratum, phenomenon, 447 Date, colloquial uses of, 447 Dates, forms of, in letters, 192 other forms used, 294 punctuation with, 293-294 Deal, vague word, 447 Declension of personal pronouns, 223 Definition, in developing paragraph, 87-88 by examples, 87-88 by use of contrast, 87
marks
with, 269 verified in dictionary, 340
Deletions in manuscript, 255
37
capital
parallel structure with,
Could
of,
all,
Definitions, italics or quotation
Co-ordinate clauses,
list
Dash, uses
410
of, illiterate,
"M"
for,
255
horizontal line in writing, 314
446
Couple, for two, several, a few, 446
meanings of, 446 Crowd, for a set, clique, 446 Cunning, defined, 446 Cute, colloquial use, 446 Criticize,
Danelaw, 6 Danish influences on English language, 6
Dangling modifiers, 392-396 absolute phrases not dangling, 393
parentheses incorrect for, 314 Demonstrative pronouns, see Pronouns, 35
Dependent
clauses, see also
Noun
clause, adjective clause, adverb
clause defined, 48
diagrams of, 48-52 misused as sentences, 206 sign of, 48 used for improving sentences, 58-61
appositives, 395
Derivations of words, value of know-
395 gerund phrase, 394
Description, paragraphing in, 74-76
elliptical clauses,
ing,
342
75-76
idiomatic exceptions, 393
example
394 participial phrase, 394 phrase of result, 394 test of dangler, 395-396 verbal phrases, 394 where acceptable, 393
writing of, 110-112 concrete details in, 110-112 dominant tone in, 110
infinitive phrase,
of,
example of, 110-112 interwoven with narrative, 110 point of view in, 110
471
INDEX Descriptions,
object, indirect,
list of:
Thomas Burke, The Wind and
the
Rain, 367 E.
Thomas
"New
Gilliard,
Guinea's
Rare Birds and Stone Age Men," 75-76 Ernie Pyle, Brave Men, 111-112 John Steinbeck, Cannery Row, 110, 367-368 George R. Stewart, Fire, 75 Virginia Woolf, Between the Acts, 367 Mark Twain, Huckleberry Finn, 25-26 Details, in developing paragraphs,
81-83 need
of, in
theme, 146
student's sources of, 81
Detract, distract, defined, 331 D:"veloping an idea, defined, 81
Developing a paragraph: by analogy, 90-91 by comparison or contrast, 88-90 by definition, 87-88 by examples or typical instances, 83-86 by methods in combination, 91-96 by particulars and details, 81-83 Device, devise, defined, 331
Dewey Decimal System,
classifying
books, 156 Diacritical marks, used in dictionaries,
340
Diagrams of sentence elements:
41-42
object of preposition, 42-50 object, retained, 41 objective complement, 41 participle,
44
phrases, 42-52 predicate, 40-52
compound, 40 42-52 prepositional phrase, 42—52 pronoun, 40-52 predicate,
preposition,
retained object, 44 sentence, complex, 48-52
compound, 48 simple, 40-47 subject, 40-52 subjective complement, 41, 238 verb,
40-52
verbal phrase, 43-45 Dialects, see Regional differences
vernacular, 25 Dialogue guides, punctuation with, 293 Dialogue, paragraphing of, 305 quotation marks with, 304 several paragraphs in length, 305 several sentences in length, 304305 with narration or description, 305 Diction, 334-370 abstract and general words, 353
appropriate words, 346-348 blanket words to be avoided, 337 boners,
237-238
adjective, 42
bookish words, 349, 353
adjective clause, 51 adjective in predicate, 41, 238 adverb, 42-49
cliches,
adverb clause, 50-52 clause, co-ordinate, 48
347-348 357-363 concreteness, 352-356
clause, subordinate,
49—52
complements, 40-44 compound subject, 40 compound verb, 40 conjunction, co-ordinating, 48 subordinating, 48-52
40-52
direct object,
gerund, 44 indirect object, 42 infinitive,
45-46
noun, 40-50
noun
clause,
49 40-52
object, direct,
472
368-370
collegiate slang in formal context,
347 colloquialisms, conciseness,
definition of key words, need of,
335
334—335 366-367 "fine writing," 362-363 general words, 353, 364-366 glossary of usage, 439-460 hackneyed phrases, 368-370 homely words, 353 idioms, 349-351 intensives, 361-362 levels of usage, 13-30 exactness, value of, figures of speech,
1
INDEX Direct address, words used
metaphors, 366 parallel structure,
pleonasm, 361 prepositions with idioms, 350-351 provincialisms, see Regional differ-
"How
slang, 347
tautology, 360
368-370
1330 vague words, to be avoided, 337 vividness and metaphor, 364-370 varieties of English, functional,
wordiness, 357-360 words similar in sound, 330-333 words twisted out of real meaning, in inexact sense,
Do
to
on on
prefix, suffix,
of,
It" articles,
122-123
336
and described,
159,
339-340
American College Dictionary, 341 Webster's New Collegiate, 344345 Dictionary of American Biography, 158 Dictionary of American English on Historical Principles, described,
159 Dictionary of National Biography,
158-159 Dictionary, to be consulted for, 338-
343
antonyms and synonyms, 343 derivation of a word, 342 grammatical information, 343 idioms, 343 meanings of words, 340 plurals of nouns, 343 principal parts of verbs, 343 pronunciation, 340 spelling, 340 synonyms and antonyms, 343 usage, 342 Didn't ought, iUiterate, 447 Differ from, differ with, idioms, 447 Different from, different than, idioms,
272 272
when not to divide, 272 Doesn't, don't, proper use of, 448 Dominant personality trait, as material for themes, 102-103 example
Dominant
sample pages from:
447
Directions, processes, etc., writing
Directive words, phrases, commas with, 290 Discourse, undesirable shift in, 403 Division of words, at end of line, 272 between double consonants, 272 on hyphen, in compound words, 272
358-360 right word, 334-370 similes, 366
Dictionaries, listed
40
of,
Complements 121-124
repetition,
336 words used
diagrams see
1
puffers, 361
triteness,
punc-
Direct object, defined, 40
periphrasis, 361
ences,
in,
tuated, 293
360
103-104
of,
tone, in description, 110
Double capacity, words understood '
in,
415
Double negative,
448 445 Double possessive, 228 Dove, dived, 448 Dramatic Index, listed, 162 Due to, caused by, owing to, 448-449 discussed,
see Can't hardly,
Each, every, everyone, etc., verb wiih, 219 reference to. in agreement, 231 -e, final, dropping of, in spelling, 326 Echo words, for coherence in paragraphs, 97 Economic Almanac, listed, 158 Education Index, listed, 162 Engineering Index, listed, 162 Effectiveness in sentences, helped by: consistent point of view, 401—405 emphatic position for important ideas,
397-398
parallel structure, 67-71,
407
periodic structure, 66-67, 398 proper subordination, 58-65
64-65 58-61 gerund phrases, 62 infinitive phrases, 62 participial phrases, 61-62 prepositional phrases, 62-63 appositives,
clauses,
473
INDEX Effectiveness in sentences
Continued
use of active voice, 400 variation in length, 56-58 variation in order, 65-66 variety of structure, 416-419 E.g., for for example, written out in
formal style, 264 Ei or ie, in spelling, 327 Either, as pronoun, number of, 219 verb with, 219 Either or, agreement of verb with nearer subject, 219 .
.
.
Elegant, excellent, defined, 449 Ellipsis marks, to indicate omissions,
277
395 Emerald, interesting etymology of, 342 Eminent, imminent, defined, 331 Emphasis, use of italics for, 270 Emphasis in sentence, 397-401 by balance, 407-410 by periodic structure, 398 by position, 397 by repetition, 359 by use of active voice, 400 by variety, 416-419 italics for, 397 list of methods to be used, 397 Elliptical clauses, dangling,
Encyclopedias, listed and described, 157 Americana, 157 Britannica, 157 Chambers's, 157 New International, 157 special encyclopedias, 157-158 Ending of theme, 147-149 anecdote, 147, 149 humorous comment, 148, 149 return to opening incident, 148 summary of main thesis, 148 English language, development of, 3— 13
family of languages, 8 Middle English period, 6-10 Modern English period, 10-11 Old English period, 5-6 periods of linguistic change, 4—11 sources of vocabulary, 4 Enthuse, colloquial, 449 Enumeration, order of arrangement in paragraph, 430 in theme, 136 Equally as good, 449
474
Etc., correct use of,
450
Etymologies, interesting, 342
Euphony and rhythm, 71-73 examples of, llL-lZ Evaluating sources, 171 Everyone, everybody, etc., number of, 231 with verb, 219 Exactness, importance of, 334-335 blanket words objectionable, 337 boners to be avoided, 337 need of definition of key words, 335 words used in inexact sense, 336
Exam, clipped form, 440 Examples, used in paragraph development, 79, 83-87 Except, for unless, 450 Excessive co-ordination, in sentence,
375-378 Excessive detail, 371-372
Exclamation point, 279-280 expression of strong feeling, 279 excessive use of,
279-280
not after mild exclamations, 279-
280 with question marks, 307 Exclamations, mild, commas after, 278-280, 287 Exclamation points, double or triple, to be avoided, 319 Experiment Station Record, described, 162 Explicit, implicit, differentiated, 332 Exposition, writing of: beginning the paper, 140-144 limiting the subject, 102, 132-133
order of presentation of material, 135 outlines for, 114-115, 134-135 paragraphs of: how to write them, 79-96 order in paragraph, 96
paragraph defined, 74—77 topic sentence in, 78 transitions in paragraph,
97-98
unity in paragraph, 96 planning a paper, 132-135 types of exposition: autobiographical sketch, 102-105 book review, 119-120 directions, 121 first impressions of college, 107
INDEX interpretation of friends,
home and
113
local color articles, 124 occupations, 114 personal essays, 128 process, explanations of, 121 profiles,
116-119
writing the paper, 144-147 Factor, vague, inexact use of, 337 Fain, feign, defined, 331 False parallel, undesirable, 410 Family of languages, 3, 8
Farther, further, differentiated, 332 Faulty co-ordination, see Subordina-
374-377
tion,
Faze, colloquial use, 450 Feel, verb, adjective complement with,
237 feeling, verbs of,
237
Fellow, for man, hoy,
Fewer,
less,
etc.,
450
For example, introducing appositive, punctuated, 293 Formal varieties of standard English, 16-21 vocabulary of, 16 Formally, formerly, defined, 332 For to, archaic, 451 Fragments, misused as sentences, 203208 correction of, 204 when used correctly, 205 Function words, importance of, 12 Functional varieties of English, 13-31 Funny, for odd, strange, 451 Further, see Farther, 332 Furthermore, conjunctive adverb, 298 punctuation with, 290 Fused sentence, see Run-together sentence, 202-212 Future time, expressed in several ways, 246-248
defined, 450
Figures, used with: dates, decimals, page numbers, street
and room numbers, 265
Figures of speech, see Metaphor, 366-
368 Final consonant, doubling Final -e, dropping, 326 Final -y, in spelling, 329
of,
328
Fine, vague word, 450 "Fine writing," undesirable, 362-363 First impressions of college,
theme
Gazetteers, listed
and described, 159-
161
Gender, agreement in, 386 General to particular, order of details, 430 General words, defined, 352 examples of, 353 Genitive, see Possessive, Case forms Gent, gentleman, lady, 451 Geographical names and addresses,
commas
with, 293-294
107-108 Fix, colloquial uses of, 450
Gerund, defined, 38
Folks, for family, relations, 451 Footnotes, in research paper, 173-177
ML A
Gerund, pronoun or noun with, 227 Gerund phrase, defined, 44 diagrams of, 44, 45 dangling, 394 for improving sentences, 62 Get, have got, etc., various uses of,
Roman
Glossary of usage, 439-460 appropriateness defined, 439
material
in,
abbreviations in, 176 examples of, 174-175 Latin terms in, 174-175, 176 Style Sheet, recommended forms, 174 numbering and spacing of, 173
numerals explained, 176— 177 where needed, 173 where unnecessary, 173 Formal introductions, avoided, 140141 Formal levels of modern usage, 14-21 For, punctuation with, 282, 284 Foreign words and phrases, when itahcized,
268
uses of, 38
451
correctness defined, 439
Grammar, 32-73 adjective and adverb, 236-240 agreement of pronoun and ante-
cedent, 231-233 agreement of subject and verb, 215-222 complete sentence. 203-214 case, 225-230
475
INDEX Grammar
Continued 32-38
Hyphens, 272-274,
definitions,
gramhiatical terms, 32-38 importance of studying, 33-34 parts of speech, 34-37 types of sentences: complex, 45
compound, 48 compound-complex, 52-53 simple, 39-46 verbals, 37-38 verbal phrases, 43—46 verb forms, 243-251 Greetings, in letters, 193 Group prepositions, 36
Guess, suppose, 451 to reference books, 158
Guides
Habitual action, expressed by, present tense, 245 would, 247
Hackneyed phrases, see Trite phrases, 368-370 Had better, had rather, idioms, 451
Had Had
451
of, illiterate,
ought, hadn't ought, 451
Handwriting, legible, 254 Hanged, hung, differentiated, 451 Hardly, in double negative, 452 Harsh combinations of sounds, see Euphony and rhythm, 71-73
Cacophony
see also
Heading,
in a letter,
191-192
Healthful, healthy^ defined, 452 Healthy, healthful, 332, 452 Hence, conjunctive adverb, 298 High-flown language, see "Fine writing"
Himself, see Pronoun
with
-self,
compounded
224
Historical present, use of, 245, 248 Hoards, hordes, defined, 332
Home and
friends,
themes about,
113-114
Homely words,
defined, 353 examples of, 353 Honorable, Reverend, not abbreviated before names, 264 Honorific adjectives, defined, 437 However, conjunctive adverb, 298 punctuation with, 290 Humor, avoidance of unintentional, 405 Hung, see Hanged, 451
476
see also Syllabica-
tion
compound compound
adjectives, 273
modifiers with beginning, 273
fractions, as modifiers,
common
273
numbers (21-99), 273 prefixes -ex, -self, 274 prepositional phrase group, 274 to avoid confusion with similar
words, 274
vowel or tripling consonant, 276 when not used: modifier in predicate, 273 simple fractions, 273 with adverbs in -ly, 273 to avoid doubling
Ibid, ibidem, in footnotes, 174, 176
words ending
in, with verb, 215, 221 Idiomatic phrases, not dangling, list of, 393 Idiomatic prepositions, list of, 350-351 faulty omission of, 415 Idioms, defined, 349 dictionary consulted for, 343 -ics,
lists of,
349-351
prepositions with, 350-351 verified in dictionary, 350 //, whether, in indirect questions, 452 Illusion, see Allusion, defined, 441 Imaginary, imaginative, defined, 332 Implicit, explicit, defined, 332 Importance of topic, methods of indicating, 145-146 In, into, proper uses of, 452 In addition to, subject of verb not
made plural by, 216 In back of, for behind, 452 Incomplete comparisons, 411-413 Incomplete sentences, see Fragments, misused sentences, 203 Incredible, incredulous, defined, 332 Indefinite pronoun, apostrophe for possessive, 226 lists of, 35, 224 you, they, in indefinite reference,
383 Indented forms, in
letters, 192 Indention, in manuscript, 255, 258 paragraphs, 255
quoted poetry, 258 to indicate quoted passage, 305
INDEX Indexes to periodicals,
listed
and de-
scribed Agricultural Index, 162 :
Art Index, 162 Dramatic Index, 162 Education Index, 162 Engineering Index, 162 Experiment Station Record, 162 Index Medicus, 162 Index to Legal Periodicals, 162 Industrial Arts Index, 162 International Index, 161 New York Times Index, 162 Poole's Index, 161 Public Affairs Information Service, 162 Quarterly Cumulative Index Medicus, 162 Reader's Guide, 161 Indirect object, defined, 40 diagramed, 41, 42 Indirect question, punctuation of, 278 Indo-European languages, 4, 8 Inductive order, in paragraphs, 431 in theme, 135 Infinitive:
dangling, 394 defined, 38
diagrams of, 45 sequence of tenses with, 248 spHt, 390 tenses of, 245, 248 uses of, 38 Infinitive phrase, dangling, 394 defined, 45 diagrams of, 45-46 for improving sentences, 62 Inflection, definition and examples of: adjectives and adverbs (comparison), 240-241 indefinite pronouns, 224 interrogative pronouns, 224 personal pronouns (declension),
223-224 relative pronouns,
224 verbs (conjugation), 244-245 Informal outline, nature of, 134 Informal varieties of standard Eng-
21-25 vocabulary of, 24-25 lish,
Informant, informer, defined, 332 Information Please Almanac, listed, 158 In regards to, for in regard to, 452
Insertions in manuscript, cated, 258
how
indi-
Inside address, in letters, 192-193 Interjection, defined, 37
O, oh,
uses, capitalization,
punctu-
ation with, 455 punctuation with, 37 Interpolations, brackets for, 315 Interpretation of home and friends.
themes about, 113-114 Interrogation point, see Question
mark, 278-279 Interrogative pronouns, see Pronouns,
35 forms of, 224 Interrupters
in
sentence,
thetical elements,
see
Paren-
289-290
defined, 289 Intrinsic, extrinsic, defined,
332
"Introduction," poor heading in outline, 139 Introductions, kind to be avoided, 145 Introductory modifier, punctuation with,
285-286
Introductory paragraph, see Beginning a theme, 140-146 Invitation, letter of, 198 Invite, for invitation,
452
Irrelevant, irreverent, defined, 332 Is
when,
is
where, in definitions, 453
Italics, uses of,
267-270
differences in usage, 267
foreign words and phrases, 269 for emphasis,
how in
270
indicated in manuscript, 267
quoted
titles,
267
musical, art compositions, 267
names of ships, aircraft, 267 words as words, letters, figures, 269 It's me, it is /, usage of, 226 Its, it's, defined, 453 Jewish Encyclopedia, listed, 158 Joint possession, apostrophe for, 301 Journalistic writing, punctuation in, 281
Key
words, need to be defined, 335 repeated for coherence, 432 Kind, sort, kind of, sort of, 453
Labeling of themes, 255 Lady, for woman, see Gentleman, lady, 451
477
INDEX Language, development
of,
3-30
importance
of books about, 31 Lay, lie, differentiated, 453
Lead, led, use of, 454 Learn, teach, meaning of, 454 Leave, let, proper uses of, 454 Legibility of handwriting, 254 Length of paragraphs, 78 Less, fewer, see Fewer, 450 Letters, business and social, 191-200 application, 196-197 body of letter, 193 complimentary close, 194 faults to avoid, 199-200 formal social letters, 198 heading, 191-192 inside address, 192-193 letterhead in, 191-192
192-193
titles in,
salutation or greeting, 193 signature, 194-195
examples 199
of, 195,
business,
196-197, 198-
195
letter of application,
196-197 196-197
exercises in:
notes on reading, 167-169 outline of, 169, 177-179
162-163 177-190 subjects for, 163-164 value of, 162-163 writing of, 151-190 Library, use of, 152-163 card catalogue, 152-156 purposes specimen
of,
of,
general reference library, 157—160 indexes to periodicals, 161-162 Lie, lay, differentiated,
453
165 importance
of,
132
of examples, 133
Line, vague use of, 454 Linguistic change, periods
of,
4—11
Lists
application for a job, 200 bread-and-butter letter, 200 explaining value of college course, 200 invitation to a friend, 200 request for salary due, 200 to newspaper,
and judging material, 152 useful information acquired, 151 limiting the subject, 164-165 sifting
list
social letters, formal,
151-152
Like, nonstandard use as adverb, 239 Like, as, as if, as conjunctions, 454 Likely, see Apt, 443 Limiting the subject, 132-133, 164-
parts of, hst, 191
personal
of,
practice in writing term papers, 151
list
200
urging members of club to pay dues, 200 Levels of usage, 13-14 functional varieties of, 13-14 reference list of books about, 31 standard English, formal level,
16-21 standard English, informal
abbreviations, 263 abbreviations in footnotes, 176 adverbs, 36 atlases and gazeteers, 159 biographical dictionaries, 158 books about language, 31 broad subjects narrowed, 133 conjunctive adverbs, 298 devices for securing emphasis in
sentences, 397 devices for securing variety in sentences,
dictionaries
416-417 and books
of synonyms,
159 level,
21-30 vernacular, 25-30
directive words and phrases, 290 encyclopedias, general and special,
157-158
Liable, see Apt, 443
faults to look for in revision of
Library of Congress, system of classifying books, 156 Library paper (term paper, research paper, etc.), 162-190 bibliography for, 166-167, 190 choosing subject, 163 deciding on general field, 163—164
manuscript, 258 idiomatic phrases, 343 indefinite pronouns, 224 periodicals, indexes to, 160-162
footnotes for, 173-175
478
prepositions, 36
pronouns, 35 indefinite, reflexive,
224 224
INDEX reference books, 157-160 spelling
syllabication, 271
spacing, 254
255 Merely, position
subordinating conjunctions, 37 trite
titles,
369-370
phrases,
words with interesting
origins,
342
Literature, histories of, 160
"Local color,"
articles, directions for
124-125 125-128 settle, 454
writing,
examples
short sentences, for variety,
56-58 Look, verb, adjective complement after, 237 Loose sentences, 66 broken up, 376 Lot, lots of, for many, much, 454
of,
388
Metaphor: defined, 366 example of, 90 for humor, 366-367
overuse
of,
Locate, for Loc. cit., in footnotes, 174, 176
Long and
258
revision,
330-332 words, 323-324
similar words,
of,
367
relation to analogy, 90 simile defined, 366 Middle English period, 6—10 additions to vocabulary, 7-9
characteristics of, 7
quotation from, 9
Might
of, illiterate, 455 Misplaced sentence elements, 387-390 adverbs {only, not, almost, nearly,
merely, scarcely), 387-388
"M" Mad,
for deletions in typing, for angry,
255
idea in dependent clause, 48,
split infinitive,
modifiers,
259 specimen pages, 256-257 see also Mechanics of printing and writing Margins, in manuscript, 255 Math, clipped form, 440 May, can, differentiated, 445 Meanings, dictionary consulted for,
340 Mechanics of printing and writing, 254-275 abbreviations, 263-266 capitalization, 255, 259-263 deletions, 255 endorsement, 255 hyphens, 271 indentions, 255 insertions in manuscript, 258
390
squinting modifier, 389 Misrelated modifiers, see Dangling
377 Majority, inaccurate use of, 455 Manuscript, form and revision, 254-
267 labels, 255 legibility, 254 margins, 255 numbers, 265 paper to be used, 254 proofreading, 258 quotation marks with
389
phrases, 388
455
Magazines, form for bibliography, 167, 168
Main
clauses,
392-396
Mixed constructions, 404 Mixed imagery, undesirable, 405 MLA Style Sheet, comment on punctuation of series, 283
recommended
footnotes, 174
rule about underlining
titles, etc.,
268
Mode,
see
Modern
Mood
English, characteristics
of.
10-31 functional varieties of, 13-31 levels of usage, 13-16 Monotony in sentence structure,
avoidance
of,
416
Mood,
or mode, indicative, 244 subjunctive, uses of, 249-250
Moreover, conjunctive adverb, punctuated, 290 Most, almost, differentiated, 455
Much
after very in verb phrase, see
Very, very much, 459 Mrs., correct use of in signature, 194195 Myself, for /, me, 224
italics,
Mythology, books on, 160
Namely, dash before, 312 titles,
268
introducing appositive, 293
479
INDEX Names, not abbreviated:
as appositive; as object of verb,
Christian, 264
verbal, preposition; as subject of verb; as subjective comple-
months, days, countries, 264 states, 264
Names
of ships, aircraft, italicized,
abstract, defined,
267
Names, when
260-261 Narrative incident, example of, 108capitalized,
109 Narration, paragraphs
Narrowing the
74
of,
Neither, verb with, 219
number
219
of, .
.
nor, either
.
.
.
.
or,
455 Nevertheless, conjunctive adverb, 298
New
English Dictionary, listed and
described, 339 Standard Dictionary, Nice, vague use of, 455
New No
listed,
good, no-good, colloquial use
339 of,
455 Nominative
case, subject of verb, 225 subjective complement, 226
225-226 None, verb with, 219 Nonrestrictive adverbial phrase,
punctuation
of,
286
commas
with,
287-289 defined, 287
Nonrestrictive prepositional phrase beginning sentence, comma after,
286
on language, 6-9 Middle English period Not, misplaced, special problem of, 387 Notes on reading, 167-169
Normal
influences
see also
care in quoting, 170 identifying sources, 169-170 note cards, form of, 169-170
samples of note cards, 171-172 skimming, 170 summarizing, 170 use of quotation marks for exact quotations, 170
Not only
.
.
.
but also, verb with,
219
Noun
clause,
uses of,
480
diagrams
49-50
of,
49-50
34
34
common, defined, 34 concrete, defined, 34 proper, defined, 34 near, nowheres near, for not nearly, 455 Number of pronoun, agreement with antecedent, 231-233, 386 anybody, everyone, etc., 231 collective nouns, 232 divided usage, 231 he, not he or she, 233 Number, undesirable shift in, 402 Numbers, proper forms, 265 figures used for, 265 hyphen used with, 265
number beginning sentence, 265 punctuation with, 265 O, oh, defined, 455 capitalization of,
uses of,
Nonrestrictive clauses,
classes of,
Nowhere
132-133
subject,
Nearly, misplaced, 388
Neither
ment, 49 Nouns, defined, 34
455
punctuation with, 455 Objects, defined and diagramed, 40-41 see also
Complements
Objective complement, defined and diagramed, 41 Obscurity in sentence, how corrected,
420-421 Occupations, papers about, 114-116 Of phrase to show possession, 228 OfJ
of,
Oh, O,
redundant
use,
456
capitalization, use, punctuation,
455
English, see Anglo-Saxon, 5-6 quotations from, 2, 9, 17
Old
Omission, see Words
left out,
414—
416 Omissions of verb endings, -s, -ed, 249 Omissions, ellipsis marks or suspen-
"One
sion points to indicate, 277 who" construction,
of those
221-222 Only, position of adverb, special problem of, 387 Op. cit., in footnotes, 174, 176 Open punctuation, in letter forms, 192
:
:
INDEX Overloaded sentences, 372-373 with, for finished, 456 Owing to, see Due to, 448-449
Order of
details in paragraphs, 96-97, 429-431
Over
chronological, 430 general to particular, 430 inductive order, 431
order of enumeration, 430 time order, 430 Orders of presenting materials in
theme chronological order, 135 inductive order, 135 enumeration, 136 order of division, 137 order of easy comprehension, 137
Organizations, explanation of, 122 suggested topics for papers, 122
Other, omitted after than, in comparisons,
412
Outlines, examples
of,
102, 114-115,
139, 140
how
writers use them, 145
nature
of,
134
process of synthesis, 134 the "outline-ridden" paper, 145
Outlines for library paper: preliminary, 169
sample
of,
177-180
sentence outline, 178-180 thesis sentence desirable,
177
indention to indicate, 74, 81
177-178 Out loud, for aloud, 456 Outlining, methods of: topic outlines,
in exposition, nature of, 77
length
conventions governing formal outline,
138-139
directions for constructing, 134-
140 "Introduction," "Body," "Conclusion," poor headings, 139 labels, consisting of figures
and
let-
138 no punctuation after topics, 138 parallelism necessary, 138 punctuation in, 138 sentence outline, nature of, 139-140 advantages of, 140 examples of, 140 single subheads undesirable, 139 topic outline, nature of, 138 examples of, 114, 139 vague topics to be avoided, 138 Outside, for except, 456 Overlapping dependence in sentence, ters,
378
Pamphlets (bulletins), form for bibliography, 167-168 Paper to be used for themes, 254 Paragraphs adequate development of, 422— 426 arrangement of details in, 96—97 chronological order, 96-97 from general to particular, 96 from particular to general, 97 as punctuation, 74 coherence in, 428-433 concrete details in, 425 connectives in, 431 defined, 74 developed by: analogy, 90-91 comparison or contrast, 88-90 definition, 87-88 details, 79-80, 81-83 examples, 80-81, 83-86 methods in combination, 91-96 particulars, 81-83 typical instances, 83—86 developing an idea, 77
of,
78
narrative, 74-75
order of details in, 96-97, 429-431 point of view in, 433-437 scrappy paragraphs, how revised,
424 topic sentences in, 78-79, 428 transitions in, 97-98, 431
conjunctions and transitional expressions, 97, 431-432 parallel structure, 97, 433
pronouns, 97, 432 repetition of key words, 97, 432 using a summarizing word, liice
432-433 426-428 used to break up a page, 11-1^ writing of, 79-100 all,
unity
in, 96,
Parallelism, see Parallel structure
and
balance, 67-71 for emphasis, 360 prepositions repeated in, 360
481
INDEX Parallel structure:
"and which, and who" constructions, 409 as means to coherence, 97, 407, 433 examples of, 68-71, 408-409 expressed in terms of grammar, 67, 407-408 false parallel, 410 for parallel elements, 67-68, 407409 for variety in sentences, 68-71 use of correlatives with, 410 Parentheses appositives, 292
inside quotation marks, to indicate omissions,
see also Ellipsis
311, 313 incorrect for deletions, 314
other marks with (comma, semicolon, period, question mark, exclamation point), 314 question mark with, to show doubt,
279 Parenthetical elements or expressions, of,
289-290
commas, dashes, parentheses, 289,
Periodic form, for emphasis, 398-399 Periodic structure, 66, 398 Periods of linguistic change, 4-1 Periphrasis, 361 Person, agreement in, 386
second, third, defined, 223 undesirable shift in, 402 Personal essays, directions for writing,
128-131 examples of, 128-131 Personal pronouns, list of, 35 declension
223-224
of,
no apostrophe
for possessive, 302 Perspective, undesirable shift in, 403
Phrases: see also Prepositional phrase. Verb phrase, Verbal phrase. Gerund phrase. Participial
phrase
tence, punctuation of,
286
appositive, misused as sentence, 207
defined, 42
42-46
diagrams
defined, 43
misplaced, 388
diagram of, 44 for improving sentences, 61-62 restrictive and nonrestrictive, 289 Participle, defined, 38 uses of, 38
and details, in developing paragraphs, 81-83 to clarify a general statement,
Particulars
81-83
junction, 36-37; interjection,
37 Party, for person, 456 Passive voice, overuse of, 250—251,
400 proper uses
of,
prepositional, misused as sentence,
206 verbal, misused as sentence,
206
"Place where" adjective clause, 50 Plagiarism, defined, 173 Planning the paper, 132 see also Outlining Plenty, defined,
456
Pleonasm, 361
Parts of speech, 34-37 see also: noun, 34; verb, 35; pronoun, 35; adjective, 35; adverb, 36; preposition, 36; con-
of,
250-251, 400
Past perfect tenses, conjugation, 244
245-246
Pejorative adjectives, defined, 437 Per cent, percentage, defined, 332,
482
and de-
160-162
scribed,
dangling, 394
456
marks
Periodical indexes, listed
311 Participial phrase, beginning sen-
uses of,
307 277
first,
compared with dashes, commas,
punctuation
Period, uses of, 277-278 after abbreviations, 277 at end of sentence, 277
Plurals of letters, figures, apos-
trophe
for, 302 checked in dictionary, 343 irregular plurals, 329 most nouns, 329 nouns ending in -/, 329 nouns ending in -o, 329 nouns ending in -s, 329 proper names, 330 Point of view, in description, 110
Plurals,
Point of view: 433-438
change
in,
consistent,
435 433
in time and space, 433-436 toward reader, 436-437
INDEX toward subject matter, 437-438 401-407
shifts in,
with passive voice of verb, 251 Poole's Index, described, 161 Poorly, colloquial for in poor health,
456
397-
398 apostrophe with, 301-302 personal pronouns, forms, 223—224 no apostrophe with, 226
Possessives,
226-228
with gerund, 227 Practicable, practical, differentiated,
456 Predicate adjective, 41 see Subjective complement Predicate substantive, 41 Prefixes ex-, self-, with, 274
when hyphens used
list of,
230
223-224
35
35 forms of, 224 two forms of possessive, 35 used to secure coherence in paragraph, 97, 432 Pronunciation, how indicated in dictionaries, 340-341 Pronouncing Dictionary of American English, listed, 342 Proofreading, importance of, 322 Proper noun, defined, 34 capitalization of, 34 Proper nouns and adjectives, capitalized, 260
456
42
diagrams of, 42-43 misused as sentence, 206
Proportion, in theme, 145 Prove, verb, adjective complement
42-43
after,
faulty omission of in idioms, of idiomatic,
415
350-351
Principal, principle, defined, 332 Principal parts of verb, defined, 243
examples of, 243 importance of, 243 Processes, explanations of,
examples
of,
237
Puffers, to be avoided, 361
Preposition, defined, 36 list
infinitive,
Proposition, proposal, differentiated,
Prepositional phrase, defined,
uses of,
with
personal, declension of, relative, list of,
Position, emphatic, in sentence^
uses of,
in clauses of comparison, 229 object of preposition, 230
121—124
122-124
suggested subjects for, 122 types of, 121 Prof, clipped form, 440 Profiles, directions for writing,
116-
117 Progressive forms of verbs,
245
Punctuation, 276-319 apostrophe, 301 brackets, 315
colon, 309-311 commas, 281-297 dash, 311-313 exclamation, 279-280 hyphen, 271-274 parentheses, 313-314 period, 277-278 question mark, 278-279 quotation marks, 304-309 semicolon, 297-301 too much punctuation, 315-319
Pronouns: appositive, case with,
233
Quantity, words denoting, verb with.
220
defined, 35 classes of,
Question, indirect, no question
35
compounded with
-self,
224-225
demonstrative, examples of, 35 forms of, 223-224 he, his, not he or she, 233 list of, 35, 224 possessive of, 224 intensive and reflexive, 224
indefinite,
interrogative,
list of,
35,
224
nominative case, 225-226 objective case, uses of, for objects,
228
228-230
319 Question mark, uses
mark
after,
commands
of,
278-279
279 278 after double questions, 279 after quoted questions, 279 incorrect to show irony or humor. 279 not after indirect question, 278 to show doubt as to fact, 279 with quotation marks, 307 after
as questions,
after direct questions,
483
INDEX Questions, shall and will in, 247 Quiet, quite, defined, 457
Quotation marks, uses
commas always
304-308
of,
inside,
idea as antecedent, 380, 384 indefinite you, they, 383
307
double marks for direct quotations,
304 for words used in special sense, 306 for slang, 306 for titles of shorter units, 306 not with indirect quotation, 305 omission of one set, 304 periods always inside, 307 quotation within quotation, 305 with dialogue guides, 307-308 with other marks, 307 with several paragraphs of dialogue, 305 with several sentences of dialogue,
304-305 words spoken of as words, 306 words used in definitions, 307 Quotations, books
of, listed,
Racial names, capitalization Raise,
rise,
260
defined, 456
Rand McNally Commercial listed,
Atlas,
160
Readers' Guide to Periodical Literature, described, 161 Real, for very, really, 457 Reason is because, discussed, 457 "Reason why" adjective clauses, 50 Redundance, see Wordiness, Concise-
ness listed,
159
appositives, clauses, phrases,
histories of literature,
with,
160
mythology, 160 quotations, 160 reference books, 158
synonyms, 159 year books, 158 Reference library, described, 157-162 Reference of pronouns, 231-233,
380-387 agreement with antecedent, 231233, 380 ambiguous, 382 clause as antecedent, 380, 384 clearness necessary, 380 definite antecedent, 380
no
287-289
Retained object, defined, 41 diagram of, 41 with passive voice, 41 Reverend, Honorable before names, not abbreviated, 264 Revision of manuscript, directions for,
254-259 importance of, 258 specimen pages, 256-257 Rhetorical patterns in sentences, 5473
euphony and rhythm, 71and periodic, 66-67,
73, loose
subordination, 58-65, variation in length, 56-58, variation in order,
encyclopedias, 157—158
484
defined, 287
see also
157-160 atlases and gazetteers, 159-160 biographical dictionaries, 158—159
Reference books
dictionaries,
Restrictive, see also Nonrestrictive
commas
160 of,
reference to one, 233 remote antecedents, 380 sentence as antecedent, 384 who, which, antecedents of, 233 Relative pronoun, as connective, 48 defined and listed, 35, 224 Remain, verb, adjective complement after, 237 Rend, rendered, defined, 333 Repetition, see Wordiness, 357-363 for effect, 358-360 awkward, 358-359 intentional, 359 similar sounds, 362 Research paper, see Library paper Respectfully, respectively, defined, 333
Rhythm
65-66
in prose sentences,
71-73
Right, for very, 458 Roman numerals, in footnotes, explained, 176-177
Run-together sentences, 209-212 corrected by adding conjunction, 210 subordination, 209 using period, 210 using semicolon, 210 see also Comma spHce Said, as reference word, 385 Salutation or greeting, in letters, 193 formal, 193 informal, 193
INDEX Same,
said, such, above, as reference
words, 385, 458 Scarcely, in double negative, 448 position in sentence, 388
Scrambled metaphors, undesirable, 405-406 Scrappy paragraphs, how revised, 424 Seem, verb, adjective complement with, 237 Seldom ever, seldom or ever, 458 Selecting an appropriate subject, 101 Self,- hyphen with, 274 -self, pronouns, use of, 224—225 Semicolon, uses of, 298-301 between main clauses, 298-300 characteristic of a formal style, 298 frequency of use, 290 to show balance or contrast, 299 with conjunctive adverbs, 298 with internal punctuation, 299 with quotation marks, 307 when not correct, 298 Senses, verbs of, adjective complements with, 237 Sentence fragment, see Fragments misused as sentences, 203 Sentence, improperly used as subject of verb, 404 Sentence sense, rules dealing with, 203-215 Sentence outline, advantages of, 140 examples of, 140 nature of, 139-140 Sentences:
67—71 choppy style in, 378 clear reference in, 380-388 complete and logical comparisons
balance
in,
long and short, for variety, 56 loose
and
in,
411-414
conciseness of expression in, 357 dangling modifiers in, 392-395 defined and diagramed, 39-52 complex, 48 compound, 48 compound-complex, 52 simple, 39
54 397-401 excessive details in, 371-373 faulty co-ordination in, 371-373 improper co-ordinaton of minor details, 372-373
effectiveness in,
emphasis
in,
periodic, 66, 398
misplaced modifiers
in,
387-390
misrelated modifiers in, 392-393 misused as subject of verb, 404 mixed constructions in, 404
mixed imagery in, 405 overlapping dependence overloaded, 372-373
in,
378
parallel structure in, 67, 360, 407-
410 periodic form in, 66, 398 problem of only, not, 387
proper arrangement
387-391
in,
repetition for emphasis in, 359 rhetorical patterns in, 54 shift in
point of view
split infinitive in,
in,
401-407
390
squinting constructions
in,
389
straggling, 376
subordination
in,
transitions in,
98
58-65, 374-380
unintentional humor in, 405 unity in, 371-374 unrelated ideas in, 371-372 upside-down subordination, 378 variety in length, 56 variety in order, 65 variety in patterns, 65, 416-419 weak passive voice, 400
words left Sequence of infinitives
awkward and obscure, 420-421 awkward repetition in, 358
371-373
logical completeness in,
414-416
out,
tenses,
and
shift in tenses,
248
participles,
248
248-249
Series, definition of,
283
283-284 Set, sit, differentiated, 458 Shall, will, should, would, 246-248 punctuation
of,
disputed usage, 247 general rule, 247 in questions, 247 should as ought to, 247 Shape, for condition, 458
401-407 404 in discourse, 402-403 in imagery, 405 in number, 402 in person, 401-402 in perspective, 403 in style, 402, 404 in subject, 403 in tense, 401-402
Shifts in point of view,
in construction,
435
INDEX Continued
view 401-402
Shifts in point of in voice,
Ships, iiames of, italicized, 267 Should, ought, uses of, 247 Signatures in letters, 194-195 legibility, 194 of married woman, 194 of unmarried woman, 194 professional titles with, 194 typed under handwritten, 194 when signed by secretary, 195
tional varieties
330-333 Simile, figure of speech, 366 Simple sentences, 39-47 Similar forms,
Stationary, stationery, defined, 333 Straight, strait, defined, 333 Student's choice of varieties of Eng-
list,
defined, 40
Skimming,
from
reading, 170-171 Slang, inappropriate in formal con-
347 237
So, as conjunction, 37, 458
458
as feminine intensive,
So So that .
,
As
443 458 see Kind, kind of, 453
as, see
.
.
,
.
as,
in clauses of purpose,
Sort, sort of,
Sources, evaluating, 171
Sources of material for writing, 101102 general fields, 102 Spacing, in typewritten manuscript,
254-255 of,
value
352
Spelling,
of,
a teacher, 118-119 "Return to the Old Home," 113114 "Washington Square," 127-128 Style, shift from formal to colloquial, 404 Profile of
Subjects for themes, selection of autobiographical incident, 105 autobiographical sketch, 102 :
descriptions,
110
directions, processes, etc., 121 first impressions of college, 107 informal book reviews, 119
friends,
local color articles, 124 narrative incident, 108 occupations, 114
320-333
326-329 330-333 the "seed" words, 327-328
rules for,
similar forms,
use of dictionary to verify, 340 verbs ending in -y, 329
words ending in words with ie or
home and
113
353
checked in dictionary, 340 doubling final consonant, 328 dropping final -e, 326 importance of, 320-321 list of words for study, 323-326 methods of learning, 322 nouns ending in -y, 329 plurals, rules for, 329 problem analyzed, 320-321 proofreading, importance of, 322
486
104-105
interpretation of
Specific words, defined, 352
examples
Student papers: "My First Taste of Maturity," "Pencil Tracks," 130
Smell, verb, adjective complement after,
29-30
lish,
in gathering material
text,
words most often misspelled, 323326 Split infinitive in modern usage, 390 Squinting modifier, 389 Standard English, characteristics of, 16-25 at formal level, 16-21 at informal level, 21-25 quoted examples from, 17-24 see also Levels of usage and func-
silent -e, ei,
327
326
personal essays, 128 profiles,
116
Subject, agreement with verb, 215-
222
220 218 introductory it, 217 not with subjective complement, 218 plural subject and verb, 215-218 plural word intervenes, 216 relative pronoun, 221 subject following verb, 217-218 title of book, etc., 220 there is, there are sentences, 217 with each, every, etc., 219 with neither nor, etc., 219 collective nouns,
compound
subject,
.
.
.
:
INDEX words added by with, together with, as well as, etc., 216 Subject, undesirable shift in, 403 Subjective complement, defined and diagramed, 41 nominative case for, 226 Subjunctive mood, uses of, 249-250 be, special problem with, 249-250 condition contrary to fact, 250 traditional forms, 250 wish or request, 250 Subordinate clauses, see Dependent clauses, 48-52 Subordinating conjunctions, 48
Swell, as word of approval, 459 Syllabication and hyphens, 271-274 awkward division of word, 271-272
37 Subordination in sentence structure:
Taste, verb, adjective
list of,
by appositives, 374 by clauses, 375-376 by phrases, 375 by reducing to single word, 375 for effectiveness, to correct
comma
58-65 fault,
compound words, 272 272 272 Synonyms and antonyms, dictionary consulted for, 343 prefixes, suffixes,
Take, conjugation of verb, 244
Take stock
Tandem
in, for
accept, believe, 459
subordination in sentence,
378
complement
237 Tautology, 360-361 Tenses after,
how
future time, illustrated,
indicated^ 246
244
past time, indicated by, 245
209
Substance in themes, use of details for,
correct division of words, 272
146-147
Such, intensive, 458 as reference word, 385 Such as, introducing appositive, punctuated, 293 Summarizing word, to clarify antecedent, 384 Superfluous commas, 315-318 after co-ordinating conjunction.
317 between adjective and noun, 316 between subject and verb, 316 between verb and complement, 316 conjunction joining two words, etc., 317 preposition and object, 316 restrictive elements, 318 Superfluous periods, 318-319 Superfluous punctuation, 315-319 commas, 315-318 dashes, 319 periods, 318 question marks, 319 quotation marks, 319 Superlative, idiomatic use for two things, 413 Sure, for certainly, surely, 459 Suspended construction, 411 Suspension points, to indicate omissions, 277 Suspicion, verb, for suspect, 459
perfect,
245
present time, 245
sequence
of,
infinitives
248
and participles, 248 248-249
shift in tenses,
undesirable shift
in,
402
Term papers, see Library papers, 151 Than and as clauses, nominative in, 225 double comparison, 411 That, double, before clause, 361 That, omitted incorrectly, 414 That is, introducing appositive, punctuated, 293, 312
Than,
That
as, in
there, this here,
wordy forms,
459
Theme
subjects:
autobiographical sketch, 102 autobiographical incident, 105 book reviews, informal, 119 descriptions, 110 directions, processes, organizations,
121 impressions of college, 107 interpretations of home and friends, 113 local color articles, 124 narrative incident, 108 occupations, 114 personal essays, 128 first
profiles,
116
Their, they're, confused, 459
487
INDEX Therefore, conjunctive adverb, 298 punctuation with, 290 Thesis sentence, explanation of, 132 examples of, 139, 140 in outlines, 177 in paragraph writing, 422 They, you, indefinite sense, 383
Time
order, see Chronological order, 76, 96,
"Time when,"
430
poetic, vulgar), 342
Vague
awkward
reference to, 386 capitalization in, 255
placing of, on page, 255 use of italics for, in print, 267 Together with, number of verb not
changed by, 216 Tone, importance of, 15 Topic outline: examples of, 114, 139 nature of, 138, 140 punctuation in, 138 Topic sentences: as aid to paragraph unity, 428 as forecast of structure in para-
graph, 96 as a separate paragraph,
colloquial, slang, obsolete,
192-
193 Titles of manuscripts:
reference, to be avoided,
78-79
safeguard of unity in paragraph, 96 used to tie several paragraphs to-
85-86
understood or implied, 79 value of, 79 Topics for themes, see Theme subjects
To, too, two, carelessly confused, 459 Transitional or directive phrases in paragraphs, 97, 431 Trite expressions, list of, 369-370 Try, and, try to, uses of, 459 Type, nonstandard use as adjective,
239
Vague words,
to be avoided, 337 Variety in sentence patterns, 416-419 begin with conjunction, 417 begin with modifier, 417 mix short and long sentences, 5658, 417 mix simple, complex, and compound sentences, 417 see also Euphony and rhythm, loose
and
periodic, subordination, variation in length Varieties of English, functional, 13 Verbals, defined, 37-38
Gerund, 38,
infinitive,
participle, 38,
38
Verbal phrase, defined, 43 gerund phrase, 44 infinitive phrase, 45 participial phrase, 43 Verb phrase, part wrongly omitted, 415 participle a part of, 38 Verbs agreement with subject, 215-222 appropriate form necessary, 243 conjugation of take, 244-245 copulative, adjectives after, 237 defined, 35
gerunds, forms and tenses, 245 historical present,
245
imperative forms, 245 infinitive forms, 245
Uncompleted comparisons, 411-413 Uncompleted constructions, 414-415
irregular,
Underlining, to indicate italics in manuscript, 267 Undeveloped paragraphs, 422-423 Unity in paragraphs, 96, 426-428 destroyed by digressions, 426 how improved, 427
principal parts, defined
488
380-
387
see also
84
positions of, 79
gether,
in sentence, 371—374 not enough, 371 too much, 371-373 Unique, most unique, 241 Upside-down subordination, 378 Usage, popular deference to "correct" usage, 20 Usage labels, in dictionary (archaic,
adjective clause, 50
Titles, personal, use in letters,
defined,
secured by topic sentence, 428
Unity
243
participles, forms
trated,
and
tenses of, 245
and
illus-
243
regular, 243
sensory (feel, taste, sound), adjective after, 237 shall, will, should,
would, 246-248
INDEX Who, whose,
subjunctive, uses of, 249-250 tenses of,
245-248
to express future time,
246-247
245 to express present time, 245 voice, passive, proper uses of, 250251 Vernacular, characteristics of, 25-29 examples of, 25-29 vocabulary of, 25 Very, very much, with verb, 459
-wise, undesirable in
ages,
to express past time,
Vividness in language, 364-370 figures of speech, 366
intensives,
365
passive, uses of,
wrong
of,
4
of,
400-401
pleonasm, 361
for,
etc.,
Webster's
459
for condition, distance,
460
New
New
International Dictionand described, 339
ary, listed
Where
at,
wordy form, 460
clause after preposition, 225
Who, whom,
World Almanac and Book
in informal usage,
Would,
of Facts,
158
in modern usage, to express habitual action, 247
spelhng, 329 listed and described, 158 Yes, no, punctuation with, 287 Yet, co-ordinating conjunction, 37 You all, Southern speech form, 460
-y, final, in
Year books,
Whether, if, see If, whether, 452 While, as conjunction, 460
Who
414-416
415 words necessary for clearness, 414 Words similar in sound, 330-333 listed,
Collegiate Dictionary,
specimen page from, 344-345 Webster's
left out,
part of verb phrase, 415 that, necessary for clearness, 414 word understood in double capacity,
459
in, out, off, dialectal,
Way, ways,
334-370
Words
in parallel series, 415
400
use of passive, 400
Wait on, for wait
English, 12 phrases, see also Diction,
Words and
idiomatic prepositions, 415
Vulgate, see Vernacular, 25-29
Want
361
periphrasis, 361
tautology, 360-361 repetition of same word, 358-359 Word order, importance of in modern
364-365 specific verbs, 365-366 verb-adverb replaced by verb, 365 Voice, active, uses
coin-
Wish, request, command, subjunctive for, 250 Without, for unless, 460 Wordiness, 357-363 circumlocution, 361
specific nouns,
Vocabulary, English, sources
awkward
239
puffers, 361
metaphor, 366 specific adjectives,
of which, reference of,
233
230
You, they, in indefinite sense, 383
489
HANDBOOK KEY GRAMMAR & USAGE 1
Sentence Fragment,
22 Exactness,
203
p.
WORDS &
PHRASEi
334
p.
2 Run-together Sentence, p. 209
23 Appropriateness: Usage,
3 Subject and Verb,
24 Idioms,
p. 21
p.
5 Adjectives
& Adverbs,
26 Conciseness, p.
352
p.
357
p.
236
27 Vividness & Metaphor, 6 Verb Forms,
EFFECTIVE SENTENCES
MECHANICS
28 Sentence Unity,
254
p.
29 Subordination,
8 Capitals, p. 259
1
Syllabication
P 1
p.
& Hyphens,
End Punctuation, p.
14 Semicolon,
p.
p.
271
^
277
15 Apostrophe,
33 Emphasis,
p.
p.
Shift in Point of
35
Parallel Structure, p.
Variety, p.
392
407
41 p.
414
416 Obscurity, p.
PARAGRAPHS
309
40 Adequate Development,
18 Parentheses & Brackets, p. 313
19 Too Much Punctuation,
p.
315
41
Unity, p.
426
42 Coherence,
43
p.
429
Point of View, p.
433
SPELLING 20 Spelling 21
List
&
Rules, p.
Similar Forms, p.
330
380
View, p. 401
p.
39 Awkwardness,
304
p.
397
p.
34
38
301
16 Quotation Marks,
17 Colon & Dash,
374
Modifiers, p.
37 WordsLeftOut,
298
p.
p.
371
Proper Arrangement, p. 387
36 Comparisons,
281 p.
31
32 Dangling
PUNCTUATION
13 Comma,
263
267
Italics, p.
p.
30 Reference of Pronouns,
9 Abbreviations & Numbers, 10
364
p.
243
p.
7 Manuscript,
346
349
p.
25 Concreteness,
223
4 Pronouns,
p.
GLOSSARY
320
44
Glossary, p.
439
p.
420
i 422
1
HANDBOOK KEY Ab
Adjectives, 5
Adv
Adverbs, 5
Agr
Agreement,
Amb Appr Arr
Awk C Cap Case CI Cnst
Coh
Mx
Abbreviations, 9
Adj
Mean
No^ 3, 4,
No pn
30
Om
Ambiguity, 22, 39
P
Appropriateness, 23
Arrangement, 31
11
Pn
Awkward, 39
Par II
Commas, 13
D Diet
Div
Emp Ex Fig
Frag
No No
punctuation, 19
Omission of words, 37 Period, 12
Paragraph, 40 Punctuation,
12-19
Parallel structure,
Period fault,
1
Prep
Prepositions,
24
39
Pron
Pronouns, 4, 30
Clearness,
Construction, 34,
PV
39
Ques Quot
Coherence, 31, 42
Ref
Rep
Danglers, 32
RS
Choice of diction, 22-27
Consdt
dictionary,
Division of word,
22
1
Emphasis, 33
^
27
Sentence fragment, Glossary,
Id
Idioms, Italics,
^
Tnse Trans
Exact word, 22 Figure of speech,
Sp Sub
1
44
24
Tr Trite
Point of view, 34,
Reference, 30
26
Repetition,
Run-together sentence, 2 Spelling,
20-21
Subordination, 29
34
Tenses, 6,
Transitions,
42
Transpose, 31 Triteness,
27
Unity, 28, 41
Vb
Verb forms, 6
Word
choice,
22-27
Awkward, 39
Wdy
Wordy, 26
Ic
Lower case (no caps), 8
WW
Wrong word, 22
Manuscript form,
7
X
43
Question mark, 12
K MS
35
Quotation marks, 16
Un
Wd
10
34
paragraph, 40
Case forms, 4
Capitals, 8
Gl Ital
construction,
Meaning obscure, 39
PF
CF Comma fault, 2 Cmp Comparisons, 36 Dug
Mixed
Obvious error